M3655idn M3660idn M3145idn M3645idnENogr2018.4
M3655idn M3660idn M3145idn M3645idnENogr2018.4
M3655idn M3660idn M3145idn M3645idnENogr2018.4
ECOSYS M3645idn
ECOSYS M3655idn
ECOSYS M3660idn
> Preface
Preface
Thank you for purchasing this machine.
This Operation Guide is intended to help you operate the machine correctly, perform routine maintenance, and take
simple troubleshooting measures as needed so that the machine can always be used in the optimum condition.
Please read this Operation Guide before using the machine.
To maintain quality, we recommend using genuine Kyocera toner containers, which must
pass numerous quality inspections.
The use of non-genuine toner containers may cause failure.
We will not be liable for any damages caused by the use of third party supplies in this machine.
A label is affixed to our replacement genuine toner containers, as shown below.
You'll need the equipment's serial number when contacting your Service Representative. Please check the number
before contacting your Service Representative.
i
Contents
Preface ..................................................................................................................................... i
Contents .................................................................................................................................. ii
Overview ................................................................................................................................ ix
Machine Features ................................................................................................................... x
Color and Image Quality Functions ................................................................................... xiv
Basic Color Modes ...................................................................................................... xiv
Adjusting Image Quality and Color............................................................................... xv
Guides Provided with the Machine .................................................................................... xvi
About the Operation Guide (this Guide) ......................................................................... xviii
Structure of the guide ................................................................................................. xviii
Conventions Used in This Guide................................................................................. xix
Menu Map ............................................................................................................................. xxi
ii
Functions key .......................................................................................................... 2-18
Display of Keys That Cannot Be Set ....................................................................... 2-19
Enter key and Quick No. Search key ...................................................................... 2-20
Help Screen ............................................................................................................ 2-21
Login/Logout ................................................................................................................... 2-22
Login ....................................................................................................................... 2-22
Logout ..................................................................................................................... 2-23
Default Settings of the Machine ..................................................................................... 2-24
Setting Date and Time ............................................................................................ 2-24
Network Setup ................................................................................................................. 2-25
Configuring the Wired Network ............................................................................... 2-25
Configuring the Wireless Network ........................................................................... 2-27
Setting Wi-Fi Direct ................................................................................................. 2-31
Energy Saver function .................................................................................................... 2-33
Low Power Mode .................................................................................................... 2-33
Sleep and Auto Sleep ............................................................................................. 2-33
Power Off Rule (models for Europe) ....................................................................... 2-34
Quick Setup Wizard ......................................................................................................... 2-35
Installing Software .......................................................................................................... 2-37
Software on DVD (Windows) .................................................................................. 2-37
Installing Software in Windows ............................................................................... 2-38
Uninstalling the Software ........................................................................................ 2-44
Installing Software in Mac Computer ...................................................................... 2-45
Setting TWAIN Driver .............................................................................................. 2-47
Setting WIA Driver ................................................................................................... 2-49
Checking the Counter ..................................................................................................... 2-50
Additional Preparations for the Administrator ............................................................. 2-51
Sending Documents to a PC ................................................................................... 2-51
Strengthening the Security ...................................................................................... 2-51
Command Center RX ...................................................................................................... 2-53
Accessing Command Center RX ............................................................................ 2-54
Changing Security Settings ..................................................................................... 2-55
Changing Device Information .................................................................................. 2-57
E-mail Settings ........................................................................................................ 2-59
Registering Destinations ......................................................................................... 2-63
Creating a New Custom Box ................................................................................... 2-64
Printing a document stored in a Custom Box .......................................................... 2-65
Transferring Data from Our Other Products ................................................................. 2-67
Migrating the Address Book .................................................................................... 2-67
iii
4 Printing from PC ..................................................................................... 4-1
Printing from PC ................................................................................................................ 4-2
Printing on Non-standard Sized Paper ...................................................................... 4-4
Banner printing .......................................................................................................... 4-5
Printer Driver Print Settings Screen .......................................................................... 4-9
Printer Driver Help ................................................................................................... 4-10
Changing the Default Printer Driver Settings (Windows 8.1) .................................. 4-10
Canceling Printing from a Computer ....................................................................... 4-10
Printing by AirPrint ......................................................................................................... 4-11
Printing by Google Cloud Print ...................................................................................... 4-11
Printing by Mopria ........................................................................................................... 4-11
Printing with Wi-Fi Direct ................................................................................................ 4-11
Printing Data Saved on the Printer ................................................................................ 4-12
Specifying the Job Box from a Computer and Storing the Job ............................... 4-12
Printing Documents from Private Print Box ............................................................. 4-13
Printing Document from Stored Job Box ................................................................. 4-15
Printing Document from Quick Copy Box ................................................................ 4-17
Printing Document from Proof and Hold Box .......................................................... 4-19
Status Monitor ................................................................................................................. 4-21
Accessing the Status Monitor .................................................................................. 4-21
Exiting the Status Monitor ....................................................................................... 4-21
Status Monitor Display ............................................................................................ 4-21
iv
How to use the FAX Function ........................................................................................ 5-36
What is Document Box? ................................................................................................. 5-37
Basic Operation for Document Box ............................................................................... 5-38
Box List Operations ................................................................................................. 5-38
Document List Operations ....................................................................................... 5-38
Using a Custom Box ....................................................................................................... 5-39
Creating a New Custom Box ................................................................................... 5-39
Editing and Deleting Custom Box ........................................................................... 5-41
Saving Scanned Documents to a Custom Box ....................................................... 5-42
Moving Documents in Custom Box ......................................................................... 5-43
Copying Documents in Custom Box into Other Boxes ............................................ 5-43
Copying Documents in Custom Box to Removable Memory .................................. 5-44
Joining Documents in Custom Box ......................................................................... 5-45
Deleting Documents in Custom Box ....................................................................... 5-46
Printing Documents in Custom Box ........................................................................ 5-46
Sending Documents in a Custom Box .................................................................... 5-47
Sending Documents in Custom Box to E-mail Address of Logged in user. ............ 5-48
Scanning Document Stored in a Custom Box ......................................................... 5-49
Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Memory ............................................ 5-50
Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB) ..................................................... 5-52
Check the USB Memory Information ............................................................................. 5-53
Removing USB Memory .................................................................................................. 5-54
Using the Manual Stapler
(ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) .............................................................. 5-55
v
Scan Resolution, Resolution ................................................................................... 6-33
E-mail Subject/Body ................................................................................................ 6-33
Long Original ........................................................................................................... 6-34
FTP Encrypted TX ................................................................................................... 6-34
Delete after Printed ................................................................................................. 6-34
Delete after Transmitted .......................................................................................... 6-34
Storing Size ............................................................................................................. 6-35
Encrypted PDF Password ....................................................................................... 6-35
JPEG/TIFF Print ...................................................................................................... 6-36
XPS Fit to Page ....................................................................................................... 6-36
vi
To Manage the Users that Send Faxes from a PC ................................................. 9-17
Local Authorization .................................................................................................. 9-18
Group Authorization Settings .................................................................................. 9-19
Guest Authorization Set. ......................................................................................... 9-22
Obtain NW User Property ....................................................................................... 9-25
Simple Login Settings ............................................................................................. 9-27
ID Card Settings ...................................................................................................... 9-30
PIN Code Authorization ........................................................................................... 9-31
Using User Login Administration .................................................................................. 9-32
Login/Logout ........................................................................................................... 9-32
Overview of Job Accounting .......................................................................................... 9-33
Enabling Job Accounting ............................................................................................... 9-34
Job Accounting Access ........................................................................................... 9-35
Setting an Account .......................................................................................................... 9-36
Adding an Account .................................................................................................. 9-36
Restricting the Use of the Machine ......................................................................... 9-37
Editing an Account .................................................................................................. 9-38
Deleting an Account ................................................................................................ 9-39
Job Accounting for Printing ..................................................................................... 9-40
Job Accounting for Scan Using TWAIN .................................................................. 9-41
Job Accounting for Scan Using WIA ....................................................................... 9-42
Job Accounting for the FAX Transmitted from a Computer .................................... 9-43
Configuring Job Accounting .......................................................................................... 9-44
Default Setting ......................................................................................................... 9-44
Counting the Number of Pages Printed .................................................................. 9-45
Print Accounting Report .......................................................................................... 9-46
Using Job Accounting .................................................................................................... 9-47
Login/Logout ........................................................................................................... 9-47
Unknown User Settings .................................................................................................. 9-48
Unknown ID Job ...................................................................................................... 9-48
Registering Information for a User whose ID is Unknown ....................................... 9-49
vii
Specifications ................................................................................................................ 11-22
Machine ................................................................................................................. 11-22
Copy Functions ..................................................................................................... 11-24
Printer Functions ................................................................................................... 11-25
Scanner Functions ................................................................................................ 11-26
Document Processor ............................................................................................. 11-27
Paper Feeder (500-sheet) (Option) ....................................................................... 11-27
Manual Stapler
(ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) .................................................... 11-28
Glossary ......................................................................................................................... 11-29
Index ............................................................................................................................ Index-1
viii
> Overview
Overview
This machine is equipped standard with copy and print functions, and a scanned image can be sent to an E-mail
recipient as an attachment or to a computer on the same network. On products with a FAX function, it is also possible to
use the fax function.
Strengthen security
(page xii)
Wi-Fi connection
Wi-Fi or Wi-Fi Direct connection
is possible.
Configuring the
Operations from your PC Wireless Network (page
2-27)
Application
You can expand the machine
functions according to your
Document needs.
Command Center RX Box functions Application (page 5-11)
You can check the status and change the
settings of the machine from a Web This function is useful for a variety of purposes,
browser on your computer. including saving data in the machine and in a USB
memory stick.
Command Center RX (page 2-53)
Command Center RX User Guide Printing Data Saved on the Printer (page 4-12)
Using a Custom Box (page 5-39)
Output Data
Copy functions Printer functions Send functions USB memory Fax functions
Copying (page 5-16) Sending (page 5-18) Saving Documents to FAX Operation
Printing from PC (page 4-1) USB Memory (Scan to Guide
USB) (page 5-52)
NOTE
• Before using the machine, be sure to read the following:
Legal and Safety Information (page 1-1)
• For preparations for use of the machine such as cable connections and software installation, refer to the following:
Installing and Setting up the Machine (page 2-1)
• To learn how to load paper, set up shared folders, and add addresses to the address book, refer to the following:
Preparation before Use (page 3-1)
ix
> Machine Features
Machine Features
The machine is equipped with many useful functions.
Using Various Functions (page 6-1)
Here are some examples.
1 2 3 1 2 3
You can preset frequently used functions. You can configure the necessary settings You can configure the necessary settings
Once you register frequently used before using the machine in the wizard before using fax in the wizard mode.
settings as favorite, you can call up the mode.
FAX Setup (page 2-35)
settings easily. Using this favorite brings Quick Setup Wizard (page 2-35)
the same results even if operated by
another person.
Favorites (page 5-6)
1 11 21 1
It is useful when preparing many-page You can send a same document to the You can save the frequently used
handouts. multiple destinations using a different document in the machine and print it
When a large number of originals cannot method. when needed.
be placed in the document processor at You can specify multiple destinations of Using a Custom Box (page 5-39)
one time, the originals can be scanned in different send methods such as E-mail,
separate batches and then copied or sent SMB, and Fax.
as one job. You can reduce your workflow by sending
Continuous Scan (page 6-24) a job at once.
Sending to Different Types of
Destinations (Multi Sending) (page 5-
28)
x
> Machine Features
Off
You can save the paper used for sending The machine is equipped with Energy You can save toner consumption with this
a FAX with this function. Saver function that automatically function.
You can send a file to be faxed from the switched into Sleep Mode. When you only need to check the printed
PC without printing the file, so that you Energy Saver function (page 2-33) content, such as a trial print run or
can reduce the number of pieces of paper documents for internal confirmation, use
and perform sending jobs efficiently. this function to save toner.
FAX Operation Guide Use this function when a high-quality print
is not required.
EcoPrint (page 6-15)
You can print originals on both sides of When there are blank pages in a scanned You can reduce the communication cost
the paper. You can also print multiple document, this function skips the blank with this function.
originals onto one sheet. pages and prints only pages that are not The communication cost can be reduced
blank. by setting the timer to the time period
Favorites (page 5-6)
Skip Blank Page (page 6-26) during which the communication cost is
low.
FAX Operation Guide
xi
> Machine Features
You can prevent image bleed-through Use the PDF format's password security You can overwrite the unnecessary data
from the reverse side when scanning thin options to restrict document viewing, that remains on the SSD automatically.
originals. printing and editing. To prevent an external leakage, the
Prevent Bleed-thrugh (page 6-17) Encrypted PDF Password (page 6- machine is able to encrypt data before
35) writing it to the SSD.
Data Security (page 8-43)
Strengthen security
Prevent loss of finished documents Log in by ID card Strengthen security
(Private Print) (Card Authentication) (Settings for Administrator)
OK !
You can temporarily save a printer You can log in simply by touching an ID Various functions are available for
document in the machine. By printing the card. You don't need to enter your user administrators to strengthen security.
document from the machine prevents name and password.
Strengthening the Security (page 2-
someone takes your document.
Card Authentication Kit(B) "Card 51)
Printing Data Saved on the Printer Authentication Kit" (page 11-3)
(page 4-12)
xii
> Machine Features
You can make the machine quiet by The functionality of the machine can be In an environment where the wireless
reducing its running noise. You can expanded by installing applications. LAN is used, you can install the machine
configure this mode by job. Applications that help you perform your without concerning the network cables. In
daily more efficiently such as a scan addition, Wi-Fi Direct, etc. are supported.
Quiet Mode (page 6-25)
feature and an authentication feature are Configuring the Wireless Network
available. (page 2-27)
Application (page 5-11) Setting Wi-Fi Direct (page 2-31)
It is useful when you need to print You can select the various file formats You can access to the machine remotely
document outside your office or you when sending/storing images. to print, send or download data.
cannot print document from your PC.
File Format (page 6-29) Administrators can configure the machine
You can print the document from the USB behavior or management settings.
memory by plugging it directly into the
machine. Command Center RX (page 2-53)
Original scanned at the machine can be
saved in the USB memory also.
Printing Documents Stored in
Removable USB Memory (page 5-
50)
Saving Documents to USB Memory
(Scan to USB) (page 5-52)
xiii
> Color and Image Quality Functions
Black & White Scans a document in black & white. page 6-15
xiv
> Color and Image Quality Functions
Sample image
I want to... Function Page
Before After
Adjust the color precisely.
xv
> Guides Provided with the Machine
Printed guides
Quick Guide
Start using the
machine quickly Explains how to use basic functions of the machine, how to use convenient features, how
to perform routine maintenance, and what to do when problems occur.
Safety Guide
Provides safety and cautionary information for installation environment and use of the
machine. Be sure to read this guide before using the machine.
For safe use of the
machine Safety Guide (ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn/
ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn)
Indicates the space required for machine installation, and describes the cautionary labels
and other safety information. Be sure to read this guide before using the machine.
xvi
> Guides Provided with the Machine
xvii
> About the Operation Guide (this Guide)
Chapter Contents
1 Legal and Safety Information Provides precautions regarding use of the machine and trademark information.
2 Installing and Setting up the Explains part names, cable connections, installation of the software, login, logout, and
Machine other matters related to administration of the machine.
3 Preparation before Use Explains preparations and settings that are required in order to use the machine, such
as how to use the operation panel, load paper, and create an address book.
4 Printing from PC Explains functions that are available when the machine is used as a printer.
5 Operation on the Machine Explains the basic procedures for using the machine, such as placing originals, making
copies, sending documents, and using document boxes.
6 Using Various Functions Explains convenient functions that are available on the machine.
7 Status/Job Cancel Explains how to check the status of a job and the job history, and how to cancel jobs
being printed or waiting to print. Also explains how to check paper and toner levels, how
to check the device status, and how to cancel fax transmission.
8 Setup and Registration (System Explains System Menu and how it relates to the operation of the machine.
Menu)
10 Troubleshooting Explains what to do when toner runs out, an error is displayed, or a paper jam or other
problem occurs.
11 Appendix Describes convenient options that are available for the machine. Provides information
on media types and paper sizes, and gives a glossary of terms. Explains how to enter
characters, and lists the specifications of the machine.
xviii
> About the Operation Guide (this Guide)
Click an item in the Table of Click to move from the current page to the previously
Contents to jump to the displayed page. This is convenient when you want to return
corresponding page. to the page from which you jumped to the current page.
IMPORTANT
Indicates operational requirements
and restrictions to operate the
machine correctly, and avoid
damage to the machine or property.
NOTE
Indicates supplemental
explanations and reference
information for operations.
Refer to
Click the underlined text to jump to
the corresponding page.
CAUTION
Indicates that personal injury or
mechanical damage may result
from insufficient attention to or
incorrect compliance with the
related points.
NOTE
The items that appear in Adobe Reader vary depending on how it is used. If the Table of Contents or tools do not
appear, refer to Adobe Reader Help.
Certain items are indicated in this guide by the conventions described below.
Convention Description
[Bold] Indicates keys and buttons.
xix
> About the Operation Guide (this Guide)
xx
> Menu Map
Menu Map
This is a list of menus displayed on the touch panel. Depending on the settings, some menus may not be displayed.
Some menu names may differ from their reference titles.
or
xxi
> Menu Map
or
Send
xxii
> Menu Map
Custom Box
xxiii
> Menu Map
xxiv
> Menu Map
Removable
Memory
xxv
> Menu Map
Polling Box
xxvi
> Menu Map
or
Status/
Job Cancel
xxvii
> Menu Map
or
System
Menu
xxviii
> Menu Map
xxix
> Menu Map
Common Settings Function Defaults FAX TX Resolution (Refer to FAX Operation Guide.)
xxx
> Menu Map
xxxi
> Menu Map
User Login/Job User Login Settings Authentication User Account Lockout Settings (page 9-4)
Accounting Security
Password Policy Settings (page 9-5)
xxxii
> Menu Map
xxxiii
> Menu Map
xxxiv
> Menu Map
xxxv
1 Legal and Safety
Information
Please read this information before using your machine. This chapter provides information on the following topics.
Notice ................................................................................................................................................................. 1-2
Safety Conventions in This Guide ........................................................................................................... 1-2
Environment ............................................................................................................................................. 1-3
Precautions for Use ................................................................................................................................. 1-4
Laser Safety (Europe) .............................................................................................................................. 1-5
SAFETY OF LASER BEAM (USA) .......................................................................................................... 1-6
Safety Instructions Regarding the Disconnection of Power ..................................................................... 1-7
Compliance and Conformity .................................................................................................................... 1-7
Other precautions (for users in California, the United States) ................................................................. 1-7
Warranty (the United States and Canada) ............................................................................................... 1-8
Legal Restriction on Copying/Scanning ................................................................................................. 1-10
EN ISO 7779 .......................................................................................................................................... 1-10
EK1-ITB 2000 ........................................................................................................................................ 1-10
Wireless Connection (Mexico only) ....................................................................................................... 1-10
Security Precautions when Using Wireless LAN (If equipped) .............................................................. 1-10
Limited Use of This Product (If equipped) ............................................................................................. 1-11
Legal Information ................................................................................................................................... 1-12
Energy Saving Control Function ............................................................................................................ 1-18
Automatic 2-Sided Print Function .......................................................................................................... 1-18
Resource Saving - Paper ....................................................................................................................... 1-18
Environmental benefits of "Power Management" ................................................................................... 1-18
Energy Star (ENERGY STAR®) Program ............................................................................................. 1-19
1-1
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Notice
Safety Conventions in This Guide
The sections of this guide and parts of the machine marked with symbols are safety warnings meant to protect the user,
other individuals and surrounding objects, and ensure correct and safe usage of the machine. The symbols and their
meanings are indicated below.
WARNING: Indicates that serious injury or even death may result from insufficient
attention to or incorrect compliance with the related points.
CAUTION: Indicates that personal injury or mechanical damage may result from
insufficient attention to or incorrect compliance with the related points.
Symbols
The symbol indicates that the related section includes safety warnings. Specific points of attention are indicated
inside the symbol.
The symbol indicates that the related section includes information on prohibited actions. Specifics of the prohibited
action are indicated inside the symbol.
The symbol indicates that the related section includes information on actions which must be performed. Specifics of
the required action are indicated inside the symbol.
Please contact your service representative to order a replacement if the safety warnings in this Operation Guide are
illegible or if the guide itself is missing (fee required).
NOTE
An original which resembles a bank note closely may not be copied properly in some rare cases because this
machine is equipped with a counterfeiting prevention function.
1-2
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Environment
The service environmental conditions are as follows:
Humidity 15 to 80%
Avoid the following locations when selecting a site for the machine.
• Avoid locations near a window or with exposure to direct sunlight.
• Avoid locations with vibrations.
• Avoid locations with drastic temperature fluctuations.
• Avoid locations with direct exposure to hot or cold air.
• Avoid poorly ventilated locations.
If the floor is delicate against casters, when this machine is moved after installation, the floor material may be damaged.
During copying, some ozone is released, but the amount does not cause any ill effect to one's health. If, however, the
machine is used over a long period of time in a poorly ventilated room or when making an extremely large number of
copies, the smell may become unpleasant. To maintain the appropriate environment for copy work, it is suggested that
the room be properly ventilated.
1-3
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
CAUTION
Do not attempt to incinerate parts which contain toner. Dangerous sparks may cause burns.
Keep parts which contain toner out of the reach of children.
If toner happens to spill from parts which contain toner, avoid inhalation and ingestion, as well as contact with your eyes
and skin.
• If you do happen to inhale toner, move to a place with fresh air and gargle thoroughly with a large amount of water. If
coughing develops, contact a physician.
• If you do happen to ingest toner, rinse your mouth with water and drink 1 or 2 cups of water to dilute the contents of
your stomach. If necessary, contact a physician.
• If you do happen to get toner in your eyes, flush them thoroughly with water. If there is any remaining tenderness,
contact a physician.
• If toner does happen to get on your skin, wash with soap and water.
Do not attempt to force open or destroy parts which contain toner.
Other precautions
Return the exhausted toner container and waste toner box to your dealer or service representative. The collected toner
container and waste toner box will be recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
Store the machine while avoiding exposure to direct sunlight.
Store the machine in a place where the temperature stays below 40 °C while avoiding sharp changes of temperature
and humidity.
If the machine will not be used for an extended period of time, remove the paper from the cassette and the Multi Purpose
(MP) Tray, return it to its original package and reseal it.
1-4
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
1-5
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
3. Maintenance
For safety of the service personnel, follow the maintenance instructions in the other section of this manual.
4. Safety switch
The power to the laser unit is cut off when the front cover is opened.
1-6
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Module name Software Ver. Frequency band in Maximum radio-frequency power transmitted in the
which the radio frequency band in which the radio equipment
equipment operates: operates:
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of
the FCC Rules.
These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This
equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the
instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference
will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television
reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the
interference by one or more of the following measures:
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
• The use of a non-shielded interface cable with the referenced device is prohibited.
CAUTION — The changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void
the user's authority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with Part 15 of FCC Rules.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions; (1) this device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including
interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
The antenna(s) used for this transmitter must be installed to provide a separation distance of at least 20 cm from all
persons and must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other transmitter.
* The above statements are valid only in the United States of America and Canada.
NOTE — Use shielded interface cables.
Other precautions
(for users in California, the United States)
Perchlorate Material - special handling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
1-7
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
KYOCERA Document Solutions America, Inc. KYOCERA Document Solutions Canada, Ltd.
225 Sand Road, P.O. Box 40008 6120 Kestrel Rd., Mississauga, ON L5T 1S8,
Fairfield, New Jersey 07004-0008, USA Canada
1-8
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
KYOCERA Document Solutions America, Inc. KYOCERA Document Solutions Canada, Ltd.
225 Sand Road, P.O. Box 40008 6120 Kestrel Rd., Mississauga, ON L5T 1S8,
Fairfield, New Jersey 07004-0008, USA Canada
1-9
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
EN ISO 7779
Maschinenlärminformations-Verordnung 3. GPSGV, 06.01.2004: Der höchste Schalldruckpegel beträgt 70 dB (A) oder
weniger gemäß EN ISO 7779.
EK1-ITB 2000
Das Gerät ist nicht für die Benutzung im unmittelbaren Gesichtsfeld am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz vorgesehen. Um
störende Reflexionen am Bildschirmarbeitsplatz zu vermeiden, darf dieses Produkt nicht im unmittelbaren Gesichtsfeld
platziert werden.
1-10
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Illegal Intrusion
A third party with malicious intent may gain unauthorized access to personal or company networks and conduct the
following illegal actions.
• Extracting personal and confidential information (information leak)
• Entering into communication while impersonating a specific person and distributing unauthorized information
(spoofing)
• Modifying and retransmitting intercepted communications (falsification)
• Transmitting computer viruses and destroying data and systems (destruction)
Wireless LAN cards and wireless access points contain built-in security mechanisms to address these problems and to
reduce the possibility of these problems occurring by configuring the security settings of wireless LAN products when
the product is used.
We recommend that customers take responsibility and use their judgment when configuring the security settings and
that they ensure that they fully understand the problems that can occur when the product is used without configuring the
security settings.
1-11
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Legal Information
Copying or other reproduction of all or part of this guide without the prior written consent of KYOCERA Document
Solutions Inc. is prohibited.
1-12
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
GPL/LGPL
This product contains GPL (http://www.gnu.org/licenses/gpl.html) and/or LGPL (http://www.gnu.org/licenses/lgpl.html)
software as part of its firmware. You can get the source code, and you are permitted to copy, redistribute and modify it
under the terms of GPL/LGPL. For further information including availability of the source code, visit
http://www.kyoceradocumentsolutions.com/gpl/.
OpenSSL License
Copyright (c) 1998-2006 The OpenSSL Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following
conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgment:
"This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit.
(http://www.openssl.org/)"
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL Project" must not be used to endorse or promote products derived
from this software without prior written permission.
For written permission, please contact openssl-core@openssl.org.
5. Products derived from this software may not be called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in their names without
prior written permission of the OpenSSL Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following acknowledgment: "This product includes software
developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org/)"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR
ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
1-13
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement:
"This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young (eay@cryptsoft.com)"
The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the routines from the library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must
include an acknowledgement: "This product includes software written by Tim Hudson (tjh@cryptsoft.com)"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e.
this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution licence [including the GNU Public Licence.]
1-14
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
10 You shall not sublicense, sell, lease, or otherwise transfer the Software and/or Typefaces without the prior written
consent of Monotype Imaging.
11 Use, duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions as set forth in the Rights in Technical Data
and Computer Software clause at FAR 252-227-7013, subdivision (b)(3)(ii) or subparagraph (c)(1)(ii), as appropriate.
Further use, duplication or disclosure is subject to restrictions applicable to restricted rights software as set forth in
FAR 52.227-19 (c)(2).
12 You acknowledge that you have read this Agreement, understand it, and agree to be bound by its terms and
conditions. Neither party shall be bound by any statement or representation not contained in this Agreement. No
change in this Agreement is effective unless written and signed by properly authorized representatives of each party.
By opening this diskette package, you agree to accept the terms and conditions of this Agreement.
Knopflerfish License
This product includes software developed by the Knopflerfish Project.
http://www.knopflerfish.org
Copyright 2003-2010 The Knopflerfish Project. All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following
conditions are met:
- Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.
- Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
- Neither the name of the KNOPFLERFISH project nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
1-15
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical transformation or translation of a Source form, including
but not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation, and conversions to other media types.
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or Object form, made available under the License, as
indicated by a copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work (an example is provided in the Appendix
below).
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object form, that is based on (or derived from) the
Work and for which the editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications represent, as a whole, an
original work of authorship. For the purposes of this License, Derivative Works shall not include works that remain
separable from, or merely link (or bind by name) to the interfaces of, the Work and Derivative Works thereof.
"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including the original version of the Work and any modifications or
additions to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to Licensor for inclusion in the Work
by the copyright owner or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner. For
the purposes of this definition, "submitted" means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent to the
Licensor or its representatives, including but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists, source code
control systems, and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the Licensor for the purpose of
discussing and improving the Work, but excluding communication that is conspicuously marked or otherwise
designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a Contribution."
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution has been
received by Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work.
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby grants to
You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable copyright license to reproduce,
prepare Derivative Works of, publicly display, publicly perform, sublicense, and distribute the Work and such
Derivative Works in Source or Object form.
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a
perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable (except as stated in this section) patent
license to make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell, import, and otherwise transfer the Work, where such license
applies only to those patent claims licensable by such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their
Contribution(s) alone or by combination of their Contribution(s) with the Work to which such Contribution(s) was
submitted. If You institute patent litigation against any entity (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit)
alleging that the Work or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct or contributory patent
infringement, then any patent licenses granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate as of the date
such litigation is filed.
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the Work or Derivative Works thereof in any medium, with
or without modifications, and in Source or Object form, provided that You meet the following conditions:
(a)You must give any other recipients of the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this License; and
(b)You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices stating that You changed the files; and
(c)You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works that You distribute, all copyright, patent, trademark,
and attribution notices from the Source form of the Work, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of
the Derivative Works; and
(d)If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its distribution, then any Derivative Works that You distribute
must include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained within such NOTICE file, excluding those notices
that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at least one of the following places: within a NOTICE text
file distributed as part of the Derivative Works; within the Source form or documentation, if provided along with the
Derivative Works; or, within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and wherever such third-party notices
normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and do not modify the
License. You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works that You distribute, alongside or as an
addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided that such additional attribution notices cannot be
construed as modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and may provide additional or different license
terms and conditions for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications, or for any such Derivative Works as
a whole, provided Your use, reproduction, and distribution of the Work otherwise complies with the conditions stated
in this License.
1-16
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explicitly state otherwise, any Contribution intentionally submitted for
inclusion in the Work by You to the Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions of this License, without any
additional terms or conditions. Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein shall supersede or modify the terms of any
separate license agreement you may have executed with Licensor regarding such Contributions.
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant permission to use the trade names, trademarks, service marks, or product
names of the Licensor, except as required for reasonable and customary use in describing the origin of the Work and
reproducing the content of the NOTICE file.
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, Licensor provides the Work (and
each Contributor provides its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF
ANY KIND, either express or implied, including, without limitation, any warranties or conditions of TITLE, NON-
INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely responsible
for determining the appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and assume any risks associated with Your
exercise of permissions under this License.
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no legal theory, whether in tort (including negligence), contract, or
otherwise, unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly negligent acts) or agreed to in writing,
shall any Contributor be liable to You for damages, including any direct, indirect, special, incidental, or consequential
damages of any character arising as a result of this License or out of the use or inability to use the Work (including
but not limited to damages for loss of goodwill, work stoppage, computer failure or malfunction, or any and all other
commercial damages or losses), even if such Contributor has been advised of the possibility of such damages.
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While redistributing the Work or Derivative Works thereof, You may choose
to offer, and charge a fee for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity, or other liability obligations and/or rights
consistent with this License. However, in accepting such obligations, You may act only on Your own behalf and on
Your sole responsibility, not on behalf of any other Contributor, and only if You agree to indemnify, defend, and hold
each Contributor harmless for any liability incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason of your
accepting any such warranty or additional liability.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
APPENDIX: How to apply the Apache License to your work.
To apply the Apache License to your work, attach the following boilerplate notice, with the fields enclosed by brackets
"[]" replaced with your own identifying information. (Don't include the brackets!) The text should be enclosed in the
appropriate comment syntax for the file format. We also recommend that a file or class name and description of
purpose be included on the same "printed page" as the copyright notice for easier identification within third-party
archives.
Copyright [yyyy] [name of copyright owner]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License"); you may not use this file except in compliance with the
License. You may obtain a copy of the License at
http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS
IS" BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the License for
the specific language governing permissions and limitations under the License.
1-17
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
Sleep
The device automatically enters Sleep when 1 minute has passed since the device was last used. The amount of time of
no activity that must pass before Sleep is activated may be lengthened.
Sleep and Auto Sleep (page 2-33)
1-18
Legal and Safety Information > Notice
1-19
2 Installing and Setting
up the Machine
This chapter provides information for the administrator of this machine, such as part names, cable connection, and
software installation.
Part Names ................................................... 2-2 Setting WIA Driver ............................ 2-49
Machine Exterior ................................. 2-2 Checking the Counter ................................. 2-50
Connectors/Interior ............................. 2-4 Additional Preparations for
With Optional Equipments Attached ... 2-6 the Administrator ......................................... 2-51
Connecting the Machine and Other Sending Documents to a PC ............ 2-51
Devices ......................................................... 2-7 Strengthening the Security ............... 2-51
Connecting Cables ........................................ 2-8 Command Center RX .................................. 2-53
Connecting LAN Cable ....................... 2-8 Accessing Command Center RX ...... 2-54
Connecting USB Cable ....................... 2-9 Changing Security Settings .............. 2-55
Connecting the Power Cable .............. 2-9 Changing Device Information ........... 2-57
Power On/Off .............................................. 2-10 E-mail Settings .................................. 2-59
Power On .......................................... 2-10 Registering Destinations ................... 2-63
Power Off .......................................... 2-10 Creating a New Custom Box ............ 2-64
Using the Operation Panel .......................... 2-11 Printing a document stored in a Custom
Operation Panel Keys ....................... 2-11 Box .................................................... 2-65
Adjusting the Operation Transferring Data from Our Other
Panel Angle ...................................... 2-12 Products ...................................................... 2-67
Touch Panel ................................................ 2-13 Migrating the Address Book .............. 2-67
Home Screen .................................... 2-13
Display for Device Information .......... 2-17
Functions key .................................... 2-18
Display of Keys That Cannot
Be Set ............................................... 2-19
Enter key and Quick No.
Search key ........................................ 2-20
Help Screen ...................................... 2-21
Login/Logout ............................................... 2-22
Login ................................................. 2-22
Logout ............................................... 2-23
Default Settings of the Machine .................. 2-24
Setting Date and Time ...................... 2-24
Network Setup ............................................ 2-25
Configuring the Wired Network ......... 2-25
Configuring the Wireless Network .... 2-27
Setting Wi-Fi Direct ........................... 2-31
Energy Saver function ................................. 2-33
Low Power Mode .............................. 2-33
Sleep and Auto Sleep ....................... 2-33
Power Off Rule
(models for Europe) .......................... 2-34
Quick Setup Wizard .................................... 2-35
Installing Software ....................................... 2-37
Software on DVD (Windows) ............ 2-37
Installing Software in Windows ......... 2-38
Uninstalling the Software .................. 2-44
Installing Software
in Mac Computer .............................. 2-45
Setting TWAIN Driver ....................... 2-47
2-1
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Part Names
Part Names
Machine Exterior
1 2 3 4 13 14
10 15
5 16
6 11
7 12
8
17
2-2
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Part Names
19
18
2-3
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Part Names
Connectors/Interior
1
2
6
4
5
8
9
10
11
12
11
13
14
2-4
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Part Names
16 17
15
18 19
15 Toner Container 18 Left Cover
16 Toner Container Lock Lever 19 Waste Toner Box
17 Registration Roller
2-5
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Part Names
2
3 7
8
4
5
2-6
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Connecting the Machine and Other Devices
USB
When Connecting the Machine to the PC or Tablet by network cable, Wi-Fi, or Wi-Fi direct
Network cable
connection
Network Wi-Fi
connection*1
Wi-Fi Direct
Tablet connection*1
*1 Only for models with the optional Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-36).
NOTE
If you are using wireless LAN, refer to the following.
Configuring the Wireless Network (page 2-27)
Connect a USB cable to the Printer/Scanner (TWAIN/WIA) USB 2.0 compatible cable (Hi-Speed USB
machine. compliant, max. 5.0 m , shielded)
IMPORTANT
Using a cable other than a USB 2.0 compatible cable may cause failure.
2-7
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Connecting Cables
Connecting Cables
Connecting LAN Cable
IMPORTANT
If the power is on, turn the power switch off.
Power Off (page 2-10)
2-8
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Connecting Cables
IMPORTANT
Only use the power cable that comes with the machine.
2-9
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Power On/Off
Power On/Off
Power On
IMPORTANT
When turning off the power switch, do not turn on the power switch again
immediately. Wait more than 5 seconds, and then turn on the power switch.
Power Off
CAUTION
If this machine will be left unused for an extended period (e.g. overnight), turn it off at the main power switch.
If the machine will not be used for an even longer period of time (e.g. vacation), remove the power plug from
the outlet as a safety precaution.
IMPORTANT
• If using the products equipped with the fax function, note that turning the machine off at the main power
switch disables fax transmission and reception.
• Remove paper from the cassettes and seal it in the paper storage bag to protect it from humidity.
2-10
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Using the Operation Panel
Sub FAX
Removable
Address Polling Box Memory
Memory
Box RX Box
Displays the System Menu/ Authenticates user Puts the machine into
Counter screen. switching, and exits the Sleep Mode. Recovers
operation for the current from Sleep if in Sleep
user (i.e. log out). Mode.
Numeric keys. Clears entered numbers Returns settings to their
Enter numbers and and characters. default states.
symbols.
2-11
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Using the Operation Panel
2-12
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Touch Panel
Home Screen
This screen is displayed by selecting the [Home] key on the operation panel. Touching an icon will display the
corresponding screen.
You can change the icons to display on the Home screen as well as its background.
Editing the Home Screen (page 2-14)
8
7
1 Select the function.
Admin
10:10
Logout 6
Home
5
2
3
Copy Send FAX Job Box
3
Sub FAX
Removable
Address Polling Box Memory
Memory
Box RX Box
* The appearance may differ from your actual screen, depending on your configuration and option settings.
FAX Sub
Removable
Polling Box Memory Address
Memory
RX Box Box
2 1 2
Status/ Device Language Paper System Favorites
Job Cancel Information Settings Menu
5 [Logout] Logs out the current user. This is displayed when user login
administration is enabled.
6 Login User Name Displays the logged-in user name. This is displayed when user login
administration is enabled. Selecting "Login User Name" will display
the information of the logged-in user.
7 Status Icon (Wi-Fi) The icon is displayed when Wi-Fi is connected. When Wi-Fi is not
connected, " " is displayed.
8 Status Icon (Error) The icon is displayed during network startup or error.
*1 A maximum of 42 icons can be displayed on products with the fax function installed. A maximum of
16 icons can be displayed for installed applications.
2-13
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
NOTE
You can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Item Description
Customize Desktop Specify the function icons to display on the desktop.
Select [ ] to display the screen for selecting the function to display. Select
the function to display and [OK].
Select an icon and [Previous] or [After] to change the display position of the
selected icon on the Desktop.
To delete an icon from desktop, select the desired one and select [ ].
2-14
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Reference
Function Icon Description
page
Copy*1 Displays the Copy screen. page 5-16
Sub Address Box*2 Displays the Sub Address Box screen. Refer to the
FAX Operation
Guide.
Send to Me (E-mail)*4 Displays the Send screen. The E-mail page 5-27
address of the logged-in user is set as
the destination.
Send to Me for Box Displays the Custom Box screen. The page 5-48
(E-mail)*3*4 E-mail address of the logged-in user is
set as the destination.
FAX Memory RX Box*2 Displays the FAX Memory RX Box Refer to the
screen. FAX Operation
Guide.
2-15
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Reference
Function Icon Description
page
Status/Job Cancel Displays the Status screen. If an error
occurs, the icon will show "!". Once the
/ -
error clears, the display will return to
normal.
Outgoing FAX Log Displays the Outgoing FAX Log screen. Refer to the
FAX Operation
Guide.
Incoming FAX Log Displays the Incoming FAX Log screen. Refer to the
FAX Operation
Guide.
2-16
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Tab Description
Identification/Network You can check ID information such as the model name, serial
number, host name and location, and the IP address.
Wi-Fi*1 You can check ID information such as the model name, serial
number, host name and location, and the IP address of the
wireless network.
FAX*2 You can check the local fax number, local fax name, local fax
ID and other fax information.
Software Ver./Capability You can check the software version and performance.
Option You can check information on the options that are used.
*1 Displayed only when the wireless network function is available on the machine.
*2 Displayed only on products with the fax function installed.
2-17
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Functions key
This screen appears when the Functions icon is selected.
Original Orientation
Top Edge on Top
Close Add/Edit
Shortcut
2-18
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Normal Hidden
Copy Send FAX Custom Box Copy Send FAX Job Box
Status/ Device Language Paper System Favorites Status/ Device Language Paper System Favorites
Job Cancel Information Settings Menu Job Cancel Information Settings Menu
NOTE
If a key that you wish to use is grayed out, the settings of the previous user may still be in effect. In this case, select
the [Reset] key and try again.
2-19
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Off On
Cancel OK
10:10
One Touch Key No. Entry
(001 - 100)
Cancel OK
2-20
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Touch Panel
Help Screen
If you have difficulty operating the machine, you can check how to operate it using the touch panel.
When the [?] (help) is displayed on the touch panel, you can select it to display the Help screen. The Help screen shows
explanations of functions and how to use them.
Example: Checking the paper selection Help screen
2
Ready to copy. 10:10 Ready to copy. 10:10
Paper Selection Paper Selection
Auto
A4 Plain
1/2 1/2
A4 Plain
A4 Plain
Cancel OK
1 Help titles
1
Ready to copy. 10:10
Paper Selection
2-21
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Login/Logout
Login/Logout
If you are setting a function that requires administrator rights, or if user login administration is enabled, you must enter
your login user name and login password.
NOTE
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
You will be unable to login if you forget your login user name or login password. In this event, login with administrator
privileges and change your login user name or login password.
Login
Normal login
Login Password
Keyboard
Login
NOTE
If [Network Authentication] is selected as the user authentication method,
authentication destinations are displayed and either [Local] or [Network] can be
selected as the authentication destination.
2 Select [Login].
2-22
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Login/Logout
Simple Login
01 A 02 B 03 C
Menu
If this screen is displayed during operations, select a user and log in.
NOTE
If a user password is required, an input screen will be displayed.
Logout
To logout from the machine, select the [Authentication/Logout] key to return to the login user
name/login password entry screen.
Users are automatically logged out in the following circumstances:
• When the machine enters the sleep state.
• When the auto panel reset function is activated.
2-23
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Default Settings of the Machine
NOTE
The default settings of the machine can be changed in System Menu.
For settings that are configurable from System Menu, refer to the following:
Setup and Registration (System Menu) (page 8-1)
NOTE
• To make changes after this initial configuration, refer to the following:
Date/Timer/Energy Saver (page 8-46)
• The correct time can be periodically set by obtaining the time from the network time server.
Command Center RX User Guide
Item Description
Time Zone Set the time difference from GMT. Choose the nearest listed location from
the list. If you select a region that utilizes summer time, configure settings
for summer time.
Date/Time Set the date and time for the location where you use the machine. If you
perform Send as E-mail, the date and time set here will be displayed on
the header.
Value: Year (2000 to 2037), Month (1 to 12), Day (1 to 31),
Hour (00 to 23), Minute (00 to 59), Second (00 to 59)
Date Format Select the display format of year, month, and date. The year is displayed
in Western notation.
Value: Month/Day/Year, Day/Month/Year, Year/Month/Day
2-24
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
Network Setup
Configuring the Wired Network
The machine is equipped with network interface, which is compatible with network protocols such as TCP/IP (IPv4),
TCP/IP (IPv6), NetBEUI, and IPSec. It enables network printing on the Windows, Macintosh, UNIX and other platforms.
Set up TCP/IP (IPv4) to connect to the Windows network.
The configuration methods are as follows
Configuration Method Description Reference Page
Configuring the Connection Use Quick Setup Wizard when configuring the network in a wizard- Quick Setup Wizard
from the Operation Panel on style screen, without setting individually in System menu. (page 2-35)
This Machine
Configuring Connections on For the equipped network interface, the connection can be set by Command Center RX
the Web Page using Command Center RX. For the optional IB-50, the connection User Guide
can be set by using the dedicated Web page. IB-50 Operation Guide
Setting the Connection by This is the setup tool included in the CD of IB-50. You can use it on IB-50 Operation Guide
Using the Setup Utility of Windows.
IB-50
NOTE
If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
If user login administration is disabled, the user authentication screen appears. Enter a login user name and
password, and select [Login].
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2-25
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
IPv4 setting
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network from System Menu, or turn the
machine OFF and then ON.
Restart Network (page 8-38)
NOTE
Ask your network administrator for the IP address in advance, and have it ready when you
configure this setting.
In the following cases, set the IP address of DNS server on the Command Center RX.
• When using the host name with "DHCP" setting set to "Off"
• When using the DNS server with IP address that is not assigned by DHCP automatically.
Setting the IP Address of the DNS Server, refer to the following:
Command Center RX User Guide
2-26
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
Use Wi-Fi Settings to configure the network in details from Wi-Fi Settings (page 8-27)
System menu.
Setting the Connection by This is the tool included in the Product Library. You can Setting the Connection by Using
Using the Wi-Fi Setup Tool configure the connection according to the instructions the Wi-Fi Setup Tool (page 2-27)
provided by the wizard.
Configuring Connections on For the IB-36, the connection can be set from the Command Center RX User
the Web Page Command Center RX. Guide
For the IB-51, the connection can be set on the dedicated IB-51 Operation Guide
Web page.
Setting the Connection by This is the setup tool included in the CD of IB-51. You can IB-51 Operation Guide
Using the Setup Utility of IB-51 use it on both Windows and Mac OS.
NOTE
When you want to switch to the network interface other than Wired (default) after installing an optional Network
Interface Kit (IB-50) and a Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-36 or IB-51), select the desired setting on "Primary
Network (Client)".
Primary Network (Client) (page 8-40)
NOTE
• Before using the Wi-Fi Setup Tool, connect your computer to this machine locally with wired LAN cable or Wi-Fi
Direct.
• To use Wi-Fi Direct, confirm that the Wi-Fi Direct is enabled (Wi-Fi Direct is set to [ON]) and Restart Network from
the operation panel, before your computer will be connected to this machine with Wi-Fi Direct.
• To use a wired LAN cable directly connected to the machine, the Auto-IP (Link-local) address will be assigned to the
machine and the computer. This machine applies Auto-IP as the default settings.
• Configure the settings on the operation panel if your computer supports WPS.
Wi-Fi Settings (page 8-27)
2-27
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
NOTE
• Installation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• If the "Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard" dialog box displays, select [Cancel].
• If the autorun screen is displayed, click [Run setup.exe].
• If the user account management window appears, click [Yes] ([Allow]).
1 2
4 Select [Maintenance].
2-28
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
NOTE
• Only one machine can be searched using Wi-Fi Setup Tool. It may take times to search
the machine.
• If the machine is not detected, select [Advanced setup] > [Next]. Select [Express] or
[Custom] as device discovery method and specify the IP address or host name to
search the machine.
5 Select [Use the device settings.] on [Authentication mode], and enter the login user
name and password. Login user name and Password are both Admin.
2-29
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
NOTE
• Installation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• If the "Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard" dialog box displays, select [Cancel].
• If the autorun screen is displayed, click [Run setup.exe].
• If the user account management window appears, click [Yes] ([Allow]).
1 2
7 Select [Maintenance].
5 Select [Use the device settings.] on [Authentication mode], and enter the login user
name and password. Login user name and Password are both Admin.
2-30
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
2 Select the network name (SSID) appeared in step 5 from the list.
2-31
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Network Setup
IMPORTANT
You can connect up to three handheld devices at the same time using Wi-Fi Direct setting. When the devices
that support Wi-Fi Direct are connected, if you want to connect other device, disconnect the already-
connected devices from the network. The disconnection methods are as follows:
• Disconnect the network from the computer or handheld computer
• Disconnecting all devices from the network on the operation panel
Select [Home] key > [Wi-Fi Direct] > [Connected Device List] > [Disconnect All]
• Configuring auto disconnecting time from the System menu
Wi-Fi Settings (page 8-27)
• Configuring auto disconnecting time from the Command Center RX
Command Center RX User Guide
2-32
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Energy Saver function
NOTE
If the Low Power Timer is equal to the Sleep Timer, a Sleep mode is preceded.
2-33
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Energy Saver function
If print data is received during Sleep, the machine automatically wakes up and starts printing.
Also when fax data arrives while the machine is in Sleep, the machine automatically wakes up and starts printing.
To resume, perform the following actions.
• Select the [Energy Saver] key.
The machine will be ready to operate within 21 seconds for ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn, and 25 seconds
for ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn.
Note that ambient environmental conditions, such as ventilation, may cause the machine to respond more slowly.
Auto Sleep
Auto Sleep automatically switches the machine into Sleep if left idle for a preset time.
The default preset time is 1 minute.
To change the preset sleep time, refer to the following:
Quick Setup Wizard (page 2-35)
Sleep Level (Energy Saver and Quick Recovery) (models except for Europe)
For sleep level, you can toggle between the following two modes: Energy Saver mode and Quick Recovery mode. The
default setting is Energy Saver mode.
Energy Saver mode reduces power consumption even more than Quick Recovery mode, and allows Sleep Mode to be
set separately for each function. The ID card cannot be recognized.
NOTE
If the optional Network Interface Kit is installed, Energy Saver cannot be specified.
2-34
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Quick Setup Wizard
4. Rings Normal
Answering Machine
FAX/TEL Switch
Paper Setup Configures the paper size and media type of paper to be used in cassettes and multi purpose
tray.
2-35
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Quick Setup Wizard
*1 FAX functions are available only on products with the fax function installed.
*2 Displayed only when the size dial on the cassette is set to "Other".
*3 Displayed only when the optional paper feeder is installed.
*4 This function is displayed when [Weekly Timer] is set to [On].
*5 This function is displayed when the optional Wireless Network Interface Kit is installed.
*6 Not displayed when "Obtain IP Address" is set to [Auto (DHCP)].
NOTE
If the user authentication screen appears, enter your login user name and login password and select [Login].
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Select a function.
NOTE
If you experience difficulty configuring the settings, refer to the following:
Help Screen (page 2-21)
Control Description
End Exits the wizard. Settings configured so far are applied.
Skip Advances to the next item without setting the current item.
2-36
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
Installing Software
Install appropriate software on your PC from the included DVD (Product Library) if you want to use the printer function of
this machine or perform TWAIN / WIA transmission or Network FAX transmission from your PC.
Express
Software Description
Install
KX DRIVER This driver enables files on a computer to be printed by the machine.
Multiple page description languages (PCL XL, KPDL, etc.) are supported by
a single driver. This printer driver allows you to take full advantage of the
features of the machine.
Use this driver to create PDF files.
KX XPS DRIVER This printer driver supports the XPS (XML Paper Specification) format -
developed by Microsoft Corporation.
KPDL mini-driver/PCL mini- This is a Microsoft MiniDriver that supports PCL and KPDL. There are some -
driver restrictions on the machine features and option features that can be used
with this driver.
FAX Driver This makes it possible to send a document created in a computer software -
application as a fax via the machine.
Kyocera TWAIN Driver This driver enables scanning on the machine using a TWAIN-compliant
software application.
Kyocera WIA Driver WIA (Windows Imaging Acquisition) is a function of Windows that enables -
reciprocal communication between an imaging device such as a scanner
and an image processing software application. An image can be acquired
using a WIA-compliant software application, which is convenient when a
TWAIN-compliant software application is not installed in the computer.
KYOCERA Net Viewer This is a utility that enables monitoring of the machine on the network. -
Status Monitor This is a utility that monitors the printer status and provides an ongoing
reporting function.
File Management Utility This makes it possible to send and save a scanned document to a specified -
network folder.
KYOCERA Net Direct Print This makes it possible to print a PDF file without starting Adobe Acrobat/ -
Reader.
FONTS These are display fonts that enable the machine's built-in fonts to be used in
a software application.
NOTE
• Installation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• Fax functionality can only be used on products equipped with fax capability.
2-37
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
• Installation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• If the "Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard" dialog box displays, select
[Cancel].
• If the autorun screen is displayed, click [Run setup.exe].
• If the user account management window appears, click [Yes].
1 2
2-38
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
You can also select [Use host name for port name] and set to use the host name of the
standard TCP/IP port. (A USB connection cannot be used.)
When you click [Install], a screen asking for your cooperation with data collection will be
displayed. Select one of the answer choices and click [OK].
IMPORTANT
If Wi-Fi or Wi-Fi Direct is enabled, be sure to specify the IP address for the port name.
Installation may fail if the host name is specified.
NOTE
• The machine cannot be detected unless it is on. If the computer fails to detect the
machine, verify that it is connected to the computer via a network or USB cable and that it
is turned on and click (Reload).
• If the Windows security window appears, click [Install this driver software anyway].
• To install Status Monitor on Windows versions preceding Windows 8, it is necessary to
install Microsoft .NET Framework 4.0 beforehand.
2-39
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
When "Your software is ready to use" appears, you can use the software. To print a test
page, click the "Print a test page" checkbox and select the machine.
Click [Finish] to exit the wizard.
If a system restart message appears, restart the computer by following the screen prompts.
This completes the printer driver installation procedure.
If you are installing the TWAIN driver, continue by configuring the following:
2-40
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
Custom Install
The following procedure is an example for installing the software in Windows 8.1 using [Custom Install].
NOTE
• Installation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• If the "Welcome to the Found New Hardware Wizard" dialog box displays, select
[Cancel].
• If the autorun screen is displayed, click [Run setup.exe].
• If the user account management window appears, click [Yes].
1 2
1
2
2-41
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
IMPORTANT
If Wi-Fi or Wi-Fi Direct is enabled, be sure to specify the IP address for the port
name. Installation may fail if the host name is specified.
NOTE
• The machine cannot be detected unless it is on. If the computer fails to detect the
machine, verify that it is connected to the computer via a network or USB cable and
that it is turned on and click (Reload).
• If the desired device does not appear, select [Add custom device] to directly select
the device.
2
3
3
2
2-42
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
4 Click [Install].
When you click [Install], a screen asking for your cooperation with data collection will be displayed.
Select one of the answer choices and click [OK].
NOTE
• To install Status Monitor on Windows versions preceding Windows 8, it is necessary to
install Microsoft .NET Framework 4.0 beforehand.
When "Your software is ready to use" appears, you can use the software. To print a test
page, click the "Print a test page" checkbox and select the machine.
Click [Finish] to exit the wizard.
If a system restart message appears, restart the computer by following the screen prompts.
This completes the printer driver installation procedure.
If you are installing the TWAIN driver, continue by configuring the following:
Setting TWAIN Driver (page 2-47)
2-43
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
Uninstallation on Windows must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows and then select [All Programs],
[Kyocera], and [Uninstall Kyocera Product Library] to display the Uninstall Wizard.
3 Finish uninstalling.
If a system restart message appears, restart the computer by following the screen prompts.
This completes the software uninstallation procedure.
NOTE
The software can also be uninstalled using the Product Library.
In the Product Library screen, click [Uninstall], and follow the on-screen instructions to
uninstall the software.
2-44
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
• Installation on MAC OS must be done by a user logged on with administrator privileges.
• When printing from a Macintosh computer, set the machine's emulation to [KPDL] or [KPDL(Auto)].
Printer (page 8-24)
• If connecting by Bonjour, enable Bonjour in the machine's network settings.
Bonjour (page 8-31)
• In the Authenticate screen, enter the name and password used to log in to the operating system.
• When printing via AirPrint, you do not have to install the software.
1 2
Install the printer driver as directed by the instructions in the installation software.
This completes the printer driver installation.
If a USB connection is used, the machine is automatically recognized and connected.
If an IP connection is used, the settings below are required.
2-45
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
1
2
2 Select [Default] and click the item that appears in "Name" and then select the driver in
"Use".
1
2
3
4
NOTE
When using an IP connection, click the IP icon for an IP connection and then enter the
host name or IP address. The number entered in "Address" will automatically appear in
"Name". Change if needed.
2-46
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
In Windows 7, select [Start] button on the Windows, [All Programs], [Kyocera] and then
[TWAIN Driver Setting]. TWAIN Driver screen appears.
2 Click [Add].
6
(USB)
1 Enter the machine name.
2-47
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
When the machine's IP address or host name is unknown, contact Administrator.
3 Finish registering.
NOTE
Click [Delete] to delete the added machine. Click [Edit] to change names.
2-48
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Installing Software
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows and enter [Scanner] in [Program and
File Search]. Click [View scanners and cameras] in the search list then the Scanners
and Cameras screen appears.
2 Select the same name as this machine from WIA Drivers, and click [Properties].
1 2
(USB)
1 Click the [Settings] tab.
1 2 Set the Compression Level.
2 3 Set units of measurement.
4 Click [OK].
3 4
2-49
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Checking the Counter
2-50
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Additional Preparations for the Administrator
Sending Documents to a PC
To Send to a Shared Folder (Send to Folder (SMB))
To send a document that has been loaded, you need to create a shared folder to receive the document on your computer.
Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC (page 3-18)
Restrict the basic functions that can be used. Local Authorization page 9-18
Prevent another user from handling the Custom Box*2 page 5-39
documents stored in the machine.
Prevent the data stored in the machine from Data Overwrite*3 Refer to the Data
being leaked. Security Kit (E)
Encryption*3 Operation Guide.
Completely delete the data on the machine Data Sanitization page 8-44
before disposing of the machine.
2-51
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Additional Preparations for the Administrator
2-52
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
Command Center RX
If the machine is connected to the network, you can configure various settings using Command Center RX.
This section explains how to access Command Center RX, and how to change security settings and the host name.
Command Center RX User Guide
NOTE
To fully access the features of the Command Center RX pages, enter the User Name and Password and click [Login].
Entering the predefined administrator password allows the user to access all pages, including Document Box,
Address Book, and Settings on the navigation menu. The factory default setting for the default user with administrator
privileges is shown below. (Upper case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).)
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
Settings that the administrator and general users can configure in Command Center RX are as follows.
Administ- General
Setting Description
rator User
Device The machine's structure can be checked.
Information
Job Status Displays all device information, including print and scan jobs, storing jobs,
scheduled jobs, and job log history.
*1
Document Box Add or delete document boxes, or delete documents within a document box.
*1
Address Book Create, edit, or delete addresses and address groups.
*1 The logged in user may not be able to configure some settings, depending on the permissions of the user.
NOTE
• FAX functions are available only on products with the fax function installed.
• Here, information on the FAX settings has been omitted.
FAX Operation Guide
2-53
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
The web page displays basic information about the machine and Command Center RX as well
as their current status.
NOTE
If the screen "There is a problem with this website's security certificate." is displayed,
configure the certificate.
Command Center RX User Guide
You can also continue the operation without configuring the certificate.
NOTE
To fully access the features of the Command Center RX pages, enter the User Name and
Password and click [Login]. Entering the predefined administrator password allows the user
to access all pages, including Document Box, Address Book, and Settings on the navigation
menu. The factory default setting for the default user with administrator privileges is shown
below. (Upper case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).)
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
2-54
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
The factory default setting for the default user with administrator privileges is shown below. (Upper
case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).)
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
2-55
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
NOTE
For details on settings related to certificates, refer to the following:
Command Center RX User Guide
2-56
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
The factory default setting for the default user with administrator privileges is shown below. (Upper
case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).)
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
2-57
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
To restart the network interface card, click [Reset] in the [Management Settings]
menu, and then click [Restart Network] in "Restart".
2-58
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
E-mail Settings
By configuring the SMTP settings, it is possible to send the images scanned by the machine as E-mail attachments and
to send E-mail notices when jobs have been completed.
To use this function, this machine must be connected to a mail server using the SMTP protocol.
In addition, configure the following.
• SMTP settings
Item: "SMTP Protocol" and "SMTP Server Name" in "SMTP"
• The sender address when the machine sends E-mails
Item: "Sender Address" in "E-mail Send Settings"
• The setting to limit the size of E-mails
Item: "E-mail Size Limit" in "E-mail Send Settings"
The procedure for specifying the SMTP settings is explained below.
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
The factory default setting for the default user with administrator privileges is shown below. (Upper
case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).)
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
2-59
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2-60
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2-61
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
Setting Description
SMTP Set to send e-mail from the machine.
SMTP Protocol Displays the SMTP protocol settings. Check that "SMTP Protocol"
is set to [On]. If [Off] is set, click [Protocol] and set the SMTP
protocol to [On].
SMTP Server Name*1 Enter the host name or IP address of the SMTP server.
SMTP Port Number Specify the port number to be used for SMTP. The default port
number is 25.
SMTP Server Timeout Set the amount of time to wait before time-out in seconds.
Authentication Protocol To use SMTP authentication, enter the user information for
authentication.
Connection Test Tests to confirm that the E-mail function is operating under the
settings without sending a mail.
Domain Restriction To restrict the domains, click the [Domain List] and enter the
domain names of addresses to be allowed or rejected. Restriction
can also be specified by e-mail address.
POP3 POP3 Protocol You don't need to set the following items when you only enable the
function of sending e-mail from the machine. Set the following
Check Interval items if you want to enable the function of receiving e-mail on the
machine.
Run once now
Command Center RX User Guide
Domain Restriction
E-mail E-mail Size Limit Enter the maximum size of E-mail that can be sent in kilobytes.
Send When E-mail size is greater than this value, an error message
Settings appears and E-mail sending is cancelled. Use this setting if you
have set E-mail Size Limit for SMTP server. If not, enter a value of
0 (zero) to enable E-mail sending regardless of the size limit.
Sender Address*1 Specify the sender address for when the machine sends E-mails,
such as the machine administrator, so that a reply or non-delivery
report will go to a person rather than to the machine. The sender
address must be entered correctly for SMTP authentication. The
maximum length of the sender address is 128 characters.
Signature Enter the signature. The signature is free form text that will appear
at the end of the E-mail body. It is often used for further
identification of the machine. The maximum length of the
signature is 512 characters.
5 Click [Submit].
2-62
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
Registering Destinations
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
1
2
5 Click [Add].
2 Click [Submit].
2-63
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
NOTE
To use Custom Box, an optional SSD must be installed in the machine.
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
1
2
4 Click [Add].
2 Click [Submit].
2-64
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2 In the address or location bar, enter the machine's IP address or the host name.
Click in the following order to check the machine's IP address and the host name.
[Device Information] in the home screen > [Identification/Network]
1
3
4 Click the number or name of the Custom Box in which the document is stored.
2-65
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Command Center RX
2 Click [Print].
2-66
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
2 Create a backup.
1 Right-click on the model name from which you want to back up the Address Book, and
select [Advanced] - [Set multiple devices].
2-67
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
5 Select [Create from device] and remove the checkmark from [Overwrite settings on
target device], and then click [Next].
2
3
2-68
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
6 Select the model you want to back up, and click [Next].
NOTE
If the "Admin Login" screen appears, enter the "Admin Login" and "Login Password", and
then click [OK]. The default settings are as follows (Upper case and lower case letters
are distinguished (case sensitive)).
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
8 Specify the location to save the file, enter the file name, and then click [Save].
For "Save as type", make sure to select "XML File".
2-69
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
9 After saving the file, always click [Cancel] to close the screen.
Please note that selecting [Finish] will write the data to the machine's Address Book.
2-70
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
5 Select [Create from file] and remove the checkmark from [Overwrite settings on target
device], and then click [Next].
2
3
Selecting the [Overwrite settings on target device] checkbox will overwrite the machine's
Address Book from entry No.1.
2-71
Installing and Setting up the Machine > Transferring Data from Our Other Products
6 Click [Browse] and select the backup Address Book file, and then click [Next].
7 Click [Finish].
2-72
3 Preparation before Use
This chapter explains the following operations.
Loading Paper .................................................................................................................................................... 3-2
Precaution for Loading Paper .................................................................................................................. 3-3
Loading in the Cassettes ......................................................................................................................... 3-4
Loading Statement in the Cassettes (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn for inch models) ........... 3-8
Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose Tray .............................................................................................. 3-11
Specifying Paper Size and Media Type ................................................................................................. 3-15
Paper Stopper .................................................................................................................................................. 3-17
Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC ................................................................... 3-18
Making a note of the computer name and full computer name .............................................................. 3-18
Making a note of the user name and domain name .............................................................................. 3-19
Creating a Shared Folder, Making a Note of a Shared Folder .............................................................. 3-20
Configuring Windows Firewall ............................................................................................................... 3-24
Registering Destinations in the Address Book ................................................................................................. 3-28
Adding a Destination (Address Book) .................................................................................................... 3-28
Adding a Destination on One Touch Key (One Touch Key) .................................................................. 3-33
3-1
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
Loading Paper
Load paper in the cassettes and multipurpose tray.
For the paper load methods for each cassette, refer to the page below.
1
2
3
4
5
6
NOTE
• The number of sheets that can be held varies depending on your environment and paper type.
• You should not use inkjet printer paper or any paper with a special surface coating. (Such paper may cause paper
jams or other faults.)
3-2
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
If you copy onto used paper (paper already used for printing), do not use paper that is
stapled or clipped together. This may damage the machine or cause poor image
quality.
NOTE
If you use special paper such as letterhead, paper with holes or paper with pre-prints like
logo or company name, refer to the following:
Paper (page 11-14)
3-3
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
NOTE
A6 paper cannot be loaded in following cassettes.
ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: Cassette 1 to 5
ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: Cassette 2 to 5
IMPORTANT
• The cassettes can hold paper with weight between 60 - 120 g/m2.
• Do not load thick paper that is heavier than 120 g/m2 in the cassettes. Use the multi purpose tray for paper
that is heavier than 120 g/m2.
NOTE
When pulling the cassette out of the machine, ensure it is supported and does not fall out.
3-4
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
2 Adjust the paper length guide to the paper size required. Press the paper length adjusting
tab and slide the guides to the paper size required.
NOTE
If you are going to use paper that is longer than A4, pull out the paper length guide
backwards.
3-5
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
3 Turn the size dial so that the size of the paper you are going to use appears in the paper
size window.
NOTE
When the size dial is set to "Other" the paper size must be set into the machine on the
operation panel.
Paper Size and Media Type for the Cassettes (page 3-15)
4 Load paper.
1 Fan the paper, then tap it on a level surface to avoid paper jams or skewed printing.
3-6
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
• Load the paper with the print side facing down.
• After removing new paper from its packaging, fan the paper before loading it in
the cassette.
Precaution for Loading Paper (page 3-3)
• Before loading the paper, be sure that it is not curled or folded. Paper that is
curled or folded may cause paper jams.
• Ensure that the loaded paper does not exceed the level indicator (see illustration
above).
• If paper is loaded without adjusting the paper length guide and paper width
guide, the paper may skew or become jammed.
3-7
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
NOTE
When pulling the cassette out of the machine, ensure it is supported and does not fall out.
2 Adjust the paper length guide to the paper size required. Press the paper length adjusting
tab and slide the guides to the A6 size.
3-8
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
3 Attach the auxiliary guide to the paper length guide as shown in the illustration.
4 Turn the size dial so that "Other" appears in the paper size window.
4 Load paper.
1 Fan the paper, then tap it on a level surface to avoid paper jams or skewed printing.
3-9
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
• Load the paper with the print side facing down.
• After removing new paper from its packaging, fan the paper before loading it in
the cassette.
Precaution for Loading Paper (page 3-3)
• Before loading the paper, be sure that it is not curled or folded. Paper that is
curled or folded may cause paper jams.
• Ensure that the loaded paper does not exceed the level indicator (see illustration
above).
• If paper is loaded without adjusting the paper length guide and paper width
guide, the paper may skew or become jammed.
NOTE
When removing the auxiliary guide, hold down the paper length adjusting tab and removing
the auxiliary guide.
3-10
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
• If you are using a paper weight of 106 g/m2 or more, set the media type to Thick and set the weight of the
paper you are using.
• Remove each transparency from the inner tray as it is printed. Leaving transparencies in the inner tray may
cause a paper jam.
NOTE
• When you load custom size paper, enter the paper size by referring to the following:
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting) (page 3-16)
• When you use special paper such as transparencies or thick paper, select the media type by referring to the
following:
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting) (page 3-16)
3-11
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
4 Load paper.
Insert the paper along the paper width guides into the tray until it stops.
After removing new paper from its packaging, fan the paper before loading it in the multi
purpose tray.
Precaution for Loading Paper (page 3-3)
3-12
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
• When loading the paper, keep the print side facing up.
• Curled paper must be uncurled before use.
• When loading paper into the multi purpose tray, check that there is no paper left
over in the tray from a previous job before loading the paper. If there is just a small
amount of paper left over in the multi purpose tray and you want to add more, first
remove the left-over paper from the tray and include it with the new paper before
loading the paper back into the tray.
• If there is a gap between the paper and the paper width guides, readjust the guides
to fit the paper in order to prevent skewed feeding and paper jams.
• Ensure that the loaded paper does not exceed the level indicator (see illustration
above).
5 Specify the type of paper loaded in the multi purpose tray using
the operation panel.
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting) (page 3-16)
3-13
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
IMPORTANT
• Use unfolded Oufuku hagaki (Return postcard).
• How to load envelopes (orientation and facing) will differ depending on the type of envelope. Be sure to
load it in correctly, otherwise printing may be done in the wrong direction or on the wrong face.
NOTE
When you load envelopes in the multi purpose tray, select the envelope type by referring to the following:
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting) (page 3-16)
3-14
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
Item Description
Paper Size*1 Metric Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Values
Cassette 1: A4, A5, A5 (Landscape)*2, A6*2, B5, B6*2, Folio, 216 × 340 mm
Cassettes 2 to 5: A4, A5, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm
*1 Only set this when the size dial on the cassette is set to "Other".
*2 ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only.
*3 The custom paper sizes are set for each cassette. Refer to the following:
Custom Paper Size (page 8-12)
*4 To change to a media type other than Plain, refer to the following:
Media Type Setting (page 8-14)
When a paper weight that cannot be loaded in the cassette is set for a media type, that media type does not appear.
*5 To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to the following:
Special Paper Action (page 8-13)
NOTE
• The available media types for printing received faxes are as shown below.
Plain, Labels, Recycled, Bond, Vellum, Color, Envelope, Thick, High Quality, Rough and Custom 1 to 8
• Set the paper size of the cassette used for fax reception as follows:
Inch models: Letter, Legal, Statement
Metric models: A4, B5, A5, Folio
If the above setting is changed, it will not be possible to print faxes.
3-15
Preparation before Use > Loading Paper
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting)
Specify the paper size and media type of paper to be used in the multi purpose tray.
Item Description
Paper Size Metric Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Values: A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm
*1 For instructions on how to specify the custom paper size, refer to the following:
Custom Paper Size (page 8-12)
*2 To change to a media type other than "Plain", refer to the following:
Media Type Setting (page 8-14)
*3 To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to the following:
Special Paper Action (page 8-13)
NOTE
• The available media types for printing received faxes are as shown below.
Plain, Label, Recycled, Bond, Vellum, Color, Envelope, Cardstock, Thick, High Quality, Rough and Custom 1 to 8
• Set the paper size of the multi purpose tray used for fax reception as follows:
Inch models: Letter, Legal, Statement
Metric models: A4, B5, A5, Folio
If the above setting is changed, it will not be possible to print faxes.
2 Select a function.
Select [Paper Setup].
3-16
Preparation before Use > Paper Stopper
Paper Stopper
When using paper A4/Letter or larger, open the paper stopper shown in the figure.
3-17
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
NOTE
Log on to Windows with administrator privileges.
NOTE
In Windows 7, from [Start] button on the Windows, select [Computer] and then [System
Properties].
In Windows 10, right-click [Start] button on the Windows and select [System].
3-18
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
3-19
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
NOTE
If there is a workgroup in System Properties, configure the settings below to limit folder access to a specific user or group.
1 Select [Settings] in charms on Desktop, and select [Control Panel], [Appearance and
Personalization], and then [Folder Options].
In Windows 7, from [Start] button on the Windows, select [Control Panel], [Appearance
and Personalization], and then [Folder Options].
In Windows 10, open up a window in File Explorer and select [View], [Options], and then
[Folder Options].
3
Remove the checkmark from [Use Sharing Wizard (Recommended)] in "Advanced settings".
1 Create a folder.
1 Create a folder on your computer.
For example, create a folder with the name "scannerdata" on the desktop.
3-20
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
2 Right-click the "scannerdata" folder, select [Property], and click [Sharing] and
[Advanced Sharing].
3-21
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
1 If the computer name that you made a note of on page 3-18 is the same as the domain
name:
If the computer name is not shown in "From this location", click the [Locations] button,
select the computer name, and click the [OK] button.
Example: PC001
If the computer name that you made a note of on page 3-18 is not the same as the
domain name:
If the text after the first dot (.) in the full computer name that you made a note of does
not appear in "From this location", click the [Locations] button, select the text after the
dot (.), and click the [OK] button.
Example: abcdnet.com
Making a note of the user name and domain name (page 3-19)
2 Enter the user name that you made a note of on page in the text box, and click the [OK]
button.
Also the user name can be made by clicking the [Advanced] button and selecting a
user.
NOTE
"Everyone" gives sharing permission to everyone on the network. To strengthen
security, it is recommended that you select "Everyone" and remove the "Read" [Allow]
checkmark.
6 Click the [OK] button in the "Advanced Sharing" screen to close the screen.
3-22
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
3-23
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
NOTE
Log on to Windows with administrator privileges.
NOTE
If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click the [Continue] button.
3-24
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
2 Add a port.
1 In charms on Desktop, click [Settings], [Control Panel], [System and Security], and
[Check firewall status].
3-25
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
5 Select [Port].
6 Select [TCP] as the port to apply the rule to. Then select [Specific local ports] and enter
"445" then click [Next].
3-26
Preparation before Use > Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC
8 Make sure all checkboxes are selected and click the [Next] button.
In Windows 7
1 In Windows 7, from [Start] button on the Windows, select [Control Panel], [System and
Security], and then [Allow a program through Windows Firewall].
If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click the [Continue] button.
In Windows 10
1 In Windows 10, right-click [Start] button on the Windows and select [Control Panel],
[System and Security], and then [Allow an app through Windows Firewall].
If the User Account Control dialog box appears, click the [Continue] button.
3-27
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
NOTE
Registering and editing of the Address Book can also be done in Command Center RX.
Registering Destinations (page 2-63)
NOTE
If user login administration is enabled, you can only edit destinations in the Address Book by logging in with
administrator privileges.
NOTE
Up to 32 characters can be entered.
Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
NOTE
Up to 256 characters can be entered.
Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
3-28
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
NOTE
For the computer name, share name, domain name, and user name, enter the information
that you noted when you created the shared folder. For details on creating shared folders,
refer to the following:
Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC (page 3-18)
Max. No. of
Item Description
Characters
Host Name Computer name Up to
256 characters
Login User Name If the computer name and domain name are the same: Up to
User Name 64 characters
For example: james.smith
If the computer name and domain name are different:
Domain name\User name
For example: abcdnet\james.smith
NOTE
• Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
• Select [Menu] > [Connection Test] to check the connection to the server you chose. If the
connection fails, check the entries you made.
3-29
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
*1 When the FTP server is based on Linux/UNIX, the path including the sub-folder is combined by the
slash "/" not using the back-slash.
NOTE
• Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
• Select [Menu] > [Connection Test] to check the connection to the FTP server you chose.
If the connection fails, check the entries you made.
2 Use [+] / [-] or the numeric keys to enter an address number (001 to 250).
To have the number assigned automatically, enter "000".
NOTE
• Address Number is an ID for a destination. A free number can be selected.
• If you specify an address number that is already in use, an error message appears.
3 Select [OK].
3-30
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
NOTE
To add a group, you need individually added destinations. Register one or more individual destinations as needed
before proceeding. Up to 100 individually registered destinations and a combined total of up to 5 SMB and FTP
destination folders can be registered in a single group.
NOTE
Up to 32 characters can be entered.
Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
2 Select [ ].
3 Select destinations (contacts) to add to the group. The selected destinations are indicated
by a checkmark in the check box.
NOTE
Destinations can be sorted or searched by destination name or address number.
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
4 Select [OK].
If you have more destinations to add, repeat Steps 2 to 4.
5 Select [End].
7 Use [+] / [-] or the numeric keys to enter an address number (001 to 250).
To have the number assigned automatically, enter "000".
NOTE
• Address Number is an ID for a destination. A free number can be selected.
• If you specify an address number that is already in use, an error message appears.
8 Select [OK].
9 Check if the selected destination was added to the group > [Save]
The group is added to the Address Book.
3-31
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
NOTE
Destinations can be sorted or searched by destination name or address number.
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
Editing a Contact
Editing a Group
3 Select [Member].
4 To delete any destination from the group, select the destination > [ ] > [Yes]
3-32
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
NOTE
• Refer to the following for use of One Touch Key.
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
• You can add One Touch keys and change their settings on Command Center RX.
Registering Destinations (page 2-63)
2
System Menu/Counter. 10:10
Address Book/One Touch - One Touch Key
001 AAA 002 BBB 003 CCC
1/9
007 None 008 None 009 None
Menu End
2 Select a destination (contact or group) to add to the One Touch Key number > [Next]
Selecting [ ] shows the detailed information of the selected destination.
NOTE
Destinations can be sorted or searched by destination name or address number.
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
3 Enter the One Touch Key name displayed in the send base screen > [Next]
NOTE
Up to 24 characters can be entered.
Refer to the following for details on entering characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
4 Select [Save].
The destination will be added to the One Touch Key.
3-33
Preparation before Use > Registering Destinations in the Address Book
2 Select a One Touch Key number (001 to 100) to edit. Selecting the [Quick No. Search] key
enables direct entry of a One Touch Key number.
The procedure differs depending on the details to be edited.
2 Edit and delete the destinations you added to One Touch Key.
Changing the Registered Information
2 Select a new destination (contact or group). Selecting [ ] shows the detailed information
of the selected destination.
10:10
Address Book (All)
Menu Cancel OK
NOTE
Destinations can be sorted or searched by destination name or address number.
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
1 Select [ ].
1/9
007 None 008 None 009 None
Menu End
2 Select [Yes].
Deletion of the data registered in the One Touch Key.
3-34
4 Printing from PC
This chapter explains the following topics:
Printing from PC ................................................................................................................................................. 4-2
Printing on Non-standard Sized Paper .................................................................................................... 4-4
Banner printing ........................................................................................................................................ 4-5
Printer Driver Print Settings Screen ......................................................................................................... 4-9
Printer Driver Help ................................................................................................................................. 4-10
Changing the Default Printer Driver Settings (Windows 8.1) ................................................................. 4-10
Canceling Printing from a Computer ...................................................................................................... 4-10
Printing by AirPrint ........................................................................................................................................... 4-11
Printing by Google Cloud Print ......................................................................................................................... 4-11
Printing by Mopria ............................................................................................................................................ 4-11
Printing with Wi-Fi Direct .................................................................................................................................. 4-11
Printing Data Saved on the Printer .................................................................................................................. 4-12
Specifying the Job Box from a Computer and Storing the Job .............................................................. 4-12
Printing Documents from Private Print Box ........................................................................................... 4-13
Printing Document from Stored Job Box ............................................................................................... 4-15
Printing Document from Quick Copy Box .............................................................................................. 4-17
Printing Document from Proof and Hold Box ......................................................................................... 4-19
Status Monitor .................................................................................................................................................. 4-21
Accessing the Status Monitor ................................................................................................................ 4-21
Exiting the Status Monitor ...................................................................................................................... 4-21
Status Monitor Display ........................................................................................................................... 4-21
4-1
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
Printing from PC
This section provides the printing method using the KX DRIVER.
NOTE
• To print the document from applications, install the printer driver on your computer from the supplied DVD
(Product Library).
• In some environments, the current settings are displayed at the bottom of the printer driver.
• When printing the cardstock or envelopes, load the cardstock or envelopes in the multi purpose tray before
performing the following procedure.
When you load envelopes or cardstock in the multi purpose tray (page 3-14)
1 2
4-2
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
3 Click "Print size" menu and select the paper size to use for printing.
To load the paper of size that is not included in print sizes of the machine such as cardstock or
envelopes, the paper size needs to be registered.
3 Start printing.
Click the [OK] button.
4-3
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
NOTE
To execute printing at the machine, set the paper size and type in the following:
Paper Size and Media Type for the Multi Purpose Tray (MP Tray Setting) (page 3-16)
4 3
5
6
7
NOTE
If you loaded a postcard or envelope, select [Cardstock] or [Envelope] in the "Media type" menu.
4-4
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
Banner printing
When a document length from 470.1 mm (18.52") to a maximum of 915.0 mm (36.03") is specified for printing, the print
job is treated as banner printing.
Follow the steps below to set banner paper in the printer driver.
2 3
4-5
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
2 1
3
4
5
1 Click the [New] button.
2 Enter the length (470.1 mm (18.52") or longer), and width of the custom paper size being
registered.
2
2 Click the [OK] button.
4-6
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
5 Load paper.
1 Open the multi purpose tray and extend the support tray section of the multi purpose tray.
2 Load paper.
4-7
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
6 Start printing.
Click the [OK] button.
When you execute printing in this case, a message appears on the machine's operation panel.
Place the paper in the Multi Purpose tray, continue to support it so that it does not fall, and
select [Continue]. To cancel printing, select [Cancel].
10:10
Job No.: xxxx Job Name: xxxxxx
IMPORTANT
After pressing [Continue], support the paper with both hands so that it feeds in
correctly.
After printing starts, catch the paper when it is output so that it does not fall. When
using the inner tray as the output location, do not stand up the stopper.
Set whether the confirmation screen appears before each sheet is printed when printing
multiple banner sheets.
4-8
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
No. Description
1 [Quick Print] tab
Provides icons that can be used to easily configure frequently used functions. Each time you click an icon, it
changes to an image resembling the print results and applies the settings.
[Basic] tab
This tab groups basic functions that are frequently used. You can use it to configure the paper size, and
duplex printing.
[Layout] tab
This tab lets you configure settings for printing various layouts, including booklet printing, combine mode,
poster printing, and scaling.
[Imaging] tab
This tab lets you configure settings related to the quality of the print results.
[Publishing] tab
This tab lets you create covers and inserts for print jobs and put inserts between sheets of OHP film.
[Job] tab
This tab lets you configure settings for saving print data from the computer to the machine. Regularly used
documents and other data can be saved to the machine for easy printing later. Since saved documents can
be printed directly from the machine, this function is also convenient when you wish to print a document that
you don't want others to see.
[Advanced] tab
This tab lets you configure settings for adding text pages or watermarks to print data.
2 [Profiles]
Printer driver settings can be saved as a profile. Saved profiles can be recalled at any time, so it's a
convenient practice to save frequently used settings.
3 [Reset]
Click to revert settings to their initial values.
4-9
Printing from PC > Printing from PC
NOTE
The Help appears, even when you click the item you want to know about and press the [F1] key on your keyboard.
1 In charms on Desktop, click [Settings], [Control Panel], and then [Devices and Printers].
2 Right-click the printer driver icon of the machine, and click the [Printer properties] menu of
the printer driver.
NOTE
When canceling printing from this machine, refer to the following:
Canceling Jobs (page 5-17)
1 Double-click the printer icon ( ) displayed on the taskbar at the bottom right of the
Windows desktop to display a dialog box for the printer.
2 Click the file for which you wish to cancel printing and select [Cancel] from the "Document"
menu.
4-10
Printing from PC > Printing by AirPrint
Printing by AirPrint
AirPrint is a printing function that is included standard in iOS 4.2 and later products, and Mac OS X 10.7 and later
products.
This function enables you to connect and print to any AirPrint compatible device without installing a printer driver.
To allow the machine to be found when printing by AirPrint, you can set machine location information in Command
Center RX.
Command Center RX User Guide
NOTE
A Google account is necessary to use Google Cloud Print. Obtain a Google account if you do not have one.
It is also necessary to register the machine with the Google Cloud Print service in advance. The machine can be
registered from a PC connected to the same network.
Printing by Mopria
Mopria is a standard on printing function included in Android 4.4 or later products. Mopria Print Service needs to be
installed and enabled in advance.
For details on how to use, refer to a Web site of Mopria Alliance.
4-11
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
Using the operation panel to specify a file within a Box and printing it.
You can print the documents from the following boxes.
Printing Documents from Private Print Box (page 4-13)
Printing Document from Stored Job Box (page 4-15)
Printing Document from Quick Copy Box (page 4-17)
Printing Document from Proof and Hold Box (page 4-19)
1 Click [File] and select [Print] in the application. The Print dialog box displays.
4 Click the [Job] tab and select the [Job storage (e-MPS)] check box to set the function.
NOTE
• To use Stored Job Box and Quick Copy Box, an optional SSD must be installed in the
machine.
• For information on how to use the printer driver software, refer to the following:
Printer Driver User Guide
4-12
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
4 Select [OK].
Printing starts.
Upon completion of printing, the Private Print job is automatically deleted.
4-13
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
1
Menu < Back Print
4-14
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
3 Select [OK].
Printing starts.
NOTE
If the document is protected by an access code, the password entry screen will be
displayed. Enter the password using the numeric keys.
4-15
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
1
Menu < Back Print
2 Select [Yes].
The document is deleted.
NOTE
If the document is protected by an access code, the password entry screen will be
displayed. Enter the password using the numeric keys.
4-16
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
NOTE
• When the number of jobs reaches the limit, the oldest job will be overwritten by the new one.
• To maintain free space on the box, you can set the maximum number of stored jobs.
Quick Copy Job Retention (page 8-22)
3 Select [OK].
Printing starts.
4-17
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
1
Menu Cancel < Back Print
2 Select [Yes].
The document is deleted.
4-18
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
3 Select [OK].
Printing starts.
4-19
Printing from PC > Printing Data Saved on the Printer
1
Menu Cancel < Back Print
2 Select [Yes].
The document is deleted.
4-20
Printing from PC > Status Monitor
Status Monitor
The Status Monitor monitors the printer status and provides an ongoing reporting function.
NOTE
When you activate Status Monitor, check the status below.
• KX DRIVER is installed.
• Either [Enhanced WSD] or [EnhancedWSD(SSL)] are set to [On] in "Network".
Network (page 8-27)
Settings icon
Expand button
Alert Tab
Toner Status Tab
Paper Tray Status Tab
Printing Progress Tab
4-21
Printing from PC > Status Monitor
Job list
Status icon
Select a job on the job list and it can be canceled using the menu displayed with a right-click.
4-22
Printing from PC > Status Monitor
Alert Tab
If an error occurs, a notice is displayed using a 3D image and a message.
• Command Center RX
If the printer is connected to a TCP/IP network and has its own IP address, use a web browser to access the
Command Center RX to modify or confirm the network settings.This menu is not displayed when using USB
connection.
Command Center RX User Guide
• Notification…
This sets the display of the Status Monitor.
Status Monitor Notification Settings (page 4-24)
• www.kyoceradocumentsolutions.com
Open our website.
• Exit
Exits the Status Monitor.
4-23
Printing from PC > Status Monitor
Select whether notification is performed when an error in the event list occurs.
NOTE
The available file format is WAV.
When customizing the message texts to read on the screen aloud, enter the texts in the text
box.
4-24
5 Operation on the Machine
This chapter explains the following topics:
Loading Originals ............................................................................................................................................... 5-2
Placing Originals on the Platen ................................................................................................................ 5-2
Loading Originals in the Document Processor ........................................................................................ 5-3
Favorites ............................................................................................................................................................ 5-6
Registering Favorite ................................................................................................................................. 5-7
Recalling Favorite .................................................................................................................................... 5-9
Editing and Deleting Favorite ................................................................................................................. 5-10
Application ....................................................................................................................................................... 5-11
Installing Applications ............................................................................................................................ 5-11
Using Applications ................................................................................................................................. 5-12
Uninstalling Applications ........................................................................................................................ 5-13
Registering Shortcuts ....................................................................................................................................... 5-14
Adding Shortcuts ................................................................................................................................... 5-14
Editing and Deleting Shortcuts .............................................................................................................. 5-15
Copying ............................................................................................................................................................ 5-16
Basic Operation ..................................................................................................................................... 5-16
Canceling Jobs ...................................................................................................................................... 5-17
Sending ............................................................................................................................................................ 5-18
Basic Operation ..................................................................................................................................... 5-19
Specifying Destination ........................................................................................................................... 5-20
Checking and Editing Destinations ........................................................................................................ 5-25
Confirmation Screen of Destinations ..................................................................................................... 5-26
Recall ..................................................................................................................................................... 5-27
Send to Me (E-mail) ............................................................................................................................... 5-27
Sending to Different Types of Destinations (Multi Sending) .................................................................. 5-28
Canceling Sending Jobs ........................................................................................................................ 5-29
WSD Scan ............................................................................................................................................. 5-30
Scanning using TWAIN or WIA .............................................................................................................. 5-32
Scanning with File Management Utility .................................................................................................. 5-33
Using fax server to send a fax (fax server transmission) ................................................................................. 5-34
Configuring Settings before Sending ..................................................................................................... 5-34
Using fax server to send a fax ............................................................................................................... 5-34
How to use the FAX Function .......................................................................................................................... 5-36
What is Document Box? .................................................................................................................................. 5-37
Basic Operation for Document Box .................................................................................................................. 5-38
Box List Operations ............................................................................................................................... 5-38
Document List Operations ..................................................................................................................... 5-38
Using a Custom Box ........................................................................................................................................ 5-39
Creating a New Custom Box ................................................................................................................. 5-39
Editing and Deleting Custom Box .......................................................................................................... 5-41
Saving Scanned Documents to a Custom Box ...................................................................................... 5-42
Moving Documents in Custom Box ........................................................................................................ 5-43
Copying Documents in Custom Box into Other Boxes .......................................................................... 5-43
Copying Documents in Custom Box to Removable Memory ................................................................. 5-44
Joining Documents in Custom Box ........................................................................................................ 5-45
Deleting Documents in Custom Box ...................................................................................................... 5-46
Printing Documents in Custom Box ....................................................................................................... 5-46
Sending Documents in a Custom Box ................................................................................................... 5-47
Sending Documents in Custom Box to E-mail Address of Logged in user. ........................................... 5-48
Scanning Document Stored in a Custom Box ....................................................................................... 5-49
Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Memory ................................................................................. 5-50
Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB) ........................................................................................ 5-52
Check the USB Memory Information ............................................................................................................... 5-53
Removing USB Memory .................................................................................................................................. 5-54
Using the Manual Stapler (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) ..................................................... 5-55
5-1
Operation on the Machine > Loading Originals
Loading Originals
Placing Originals on the Platen
You may place books or magazines on the platen in addition to ordinary sheet originals.
NOTE
For details on Original Orientation, refer to the following:
Original Orientation (page 6-12)
NOTE
For the procedure for feeding envelopes or cardstock, refer to the following:
When you load envelopes or cardstock in the multi purpose tray (page 3-14)
CAUTION
Do not leave the document processor open as there is a danger of personal injury.
IMPORTANT
• Do not push the document processor forcefully when you close it. Excessive pressure may crack the platen
glass.
• When placing books or magazines on the machine, do so with the document processor in the open
position.
5-2
Operation on the Machine > Loading Originals
Sizes Maximum 216 x 355.6 mm (Long-sized 216 x 915 mm) to Minimum 105 x 148 mm
IMPORTANT
• Before loading originals, be sure that there are no originals left on the original eject table. Originals left on
the original eject table may cause the new originals to jam.
• Do not make an impact on the document processor top cover, such as aligning the originals on the top
cover. It may cause an error in the document processor.
5-3
Operation on the Machine > Loading Originals
NOTE
For details on Original Orientation, refer to the following:
Original Orientation (page 6-12)
IMPORTANT
Confirm that the original width guides exactly fit the originals. If there is a gap,
readjust the original width guides. The gap may cause the originals to jam.
Ensure that loaded originals do not exceed the level indicator. Exceeding the
maximum level may cause the originals to jam.
Originals with punched holes or perforated lines should be placed in such a way
that the holes or perforations will be scanned last (not first).
5-4
Operation on the Machine > Loading Originals
2 Open the original stopper to fit the size of the original set.
5-5
Operation on the Machine > Favorites
Favorites
Frequently used functions can be registered as favorites so that they can be called up easily.
The following functions are pre-registered on this machine. You can delete these functions as well as register new
functions.
Paper Saving Copy Use this when you want to reduce paper use. • Copying Functions
Page combining and two-sided copying can be • Wizard mode
set by following the screen.
• Combine: [2 in 1]
Duplex: [1-sided>>2-sided]
Paper Selection: Cassette 1
Copies: 1
Scan to PC (Address Use this when you want to send the image to • Sending Functions
Entry) either a shared folder on a PC or an FTP server • Wizard mode
folder. The settings such as the destination and
color selection can be set by following the screen. • Destination: New PC Folder
Color Selection: [Full Color]
File Name Entry: Default
File Format: [PDF]
Continuous Scan: [Off]
Scan Resolution: [300×300 dpi]
Scan to PC (Address Use this when you want to send the image to • Sending Functions
Book) either a shared folder on a PC registered in the • Wizard mode
Address Book or to an FTP server folder. The
settings such as the destination and color • Destination: Address Book
selection can be set by following the screen. Color Selection: [Full Color]
File Name Entry: Default
File Format: [PDF]
Continuous Scan: [Off]
Scan Resolution: [300×300 dpi]
Scan to E-mail (Address Use this when you want to send the image to an • Sending Functions
Entry) E-mail address. The settings such as the • Wizard mode
destination and color selection can be set by
following the screen. • Destination: New E-mail Address
Color Selection: [Full Color]
File Name Entry: Default
File Format: [PDF]
Continuous Scan: [Off]
Scan Resolution: [300×300 dpi]
E-mail subject: Default
E-mail body: Default
5-6
Operation on the Machine > Favorites
NOTE
Up to 20 settings can be registered as favorites.
Registering Favorite
When registering a favorite, you can choose from two methods for calling it up:
• Wizard mode: Registered settings are called up in order and configured as you check or change each one.
• Program mode: Settings are called up immediately when you select the key to which they are registered.
Sending is explained as an example below.
Wizard Mode
3 Select [Wizard].
NOTE
When the job type is "Copy", the Destination Recall Method screen will not be displayed.
5-7
Operation on the Machine > Favorites
Item Description
Name Enter the name displayed on the favorite screen (up to 32 characters).
*1 If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with
administrator privileges.
*2 Displayed when user login administration is enabled.
*3 Displayed when the job type is [Send] or [FAX].
7 Select [Save].
The favorite is registered.
8 "Do you want to add a new function to the home screen?" screen appears.To display a
registered favorite on the Home screen, select [Yes] and specify the position in which you
want to display the icon of registered favorite, and select [Save].
Program Mode
When registering favorites in program mode, configure the copy function, send function, fax function (Only on products
with the fax function installed.), destination, or other setting to register.
2 Select the sending functions and destinations that you want to register in the program.
3 Select [Favorites].
3 Select [Program].
5-8
Operation on the Machine > Favorites
Item Description
Name Enter the name displayed on the favorite screen (up to 32 characters).
*1 If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with
administrator privileges.
*2 Displayed when user login administration is enabled.
6 Select [Save].
The favorite is registered.
7 "Do you want to add a new function to the home screen?" screen appears. To display a
registered favorite on the Home screen, select [Yes] and specify the position in which you
want to display the icon of registered favorite, and select [Save].
Recalling Favorite
Use the procedure below to recall a registered favorite.
1 The registered screens are displayed in order. Make the desired settings and select [Next].
When all the settings are complete, the confirmation screen is displayed.
NOTE
To edit the settings, select [<Back] and make changes as desired.
5-9
Operation on the Machine > Favorites
To edit a favorite
To delete
3 Select [Yes].
5-10
Operation on the Machine > Application
Application
The functionality of the machine can be expanded by installing applications.
Applications that help you perform your daily more efficiently such as a scan feature and an authentication feature are
available.
For details, consult your sales representative or dealer.
Installing Applications
To use applications, first install the application in the machine and then activate the application.
NOTE
A maximum of 16 applications and 5 licenses can be installed on the machine. To add different applications, uninstall
an application that has been installed.
Uninstalling Applications (page 5-13)
NOTE
If the user authentication screen appears, enter your login user name and login password
and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator privileges. The factory
default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Insert the removable memory containing the application to be installed into the USB
Memory Slot.
NOTE
When the message "Removable Memory was recognized. Displaying files. Are you
sure?" is displayed, select [No].
5-11
Operation on the Machine > Application
4 Select [Yes].
Installation of the application begins. Depending on the application being installed, the installation
may take some time.
Once the installation ends, the original screen reappears.
NOTE
• To install another application, repeat steps 2-3 and 2-4.
• To remove the removable memory, select [Remove Memory] and wait until the
message "Removable Memory can be safely removed." appears. Then remove the
removable memory.
3 Select [Yes].
IMPORTANT
If you change the date/time while using the trial version of an application, you will
no longer be able to use the application.
Using Applications
Icons of activated application are displayed in the Home screen. Select the application icon in the Home screen.
The application will start up.
5-12
Operation on the Machine > Application
Uninstalling Applications
The procedure is as follows.
NOTE
If the user authentication screen appears, enter your login user name and login password
and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator privileges. The factory
default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Select [Yes].
2 Select [Yes].
5-13
Operation on the Machine > Registering Shortcuts
Registering Shortcuts
You can register shortcuts for easy access to the frequently used functions. The settings for the selected function can
also be registered. A function name linked to a registered shortcut can be changed as necessary. You can register up to
2 shortcuts for copying functions, sending functions, fax functions, and functions set for document box.
Adding Shortcuts
Shortcut registration is performed in the "Functions" screen of each function. Use the procedure below to register a
shortcut.
Private Shortcut 1, 2 Private shortcuts are only available for use by the logged in user.
They can only be set while using user login administration.
Shared Shortcut 1, 2 Shared shortcuts can be used by all machine users. When using user
login administration, shared shortcuts can only be set by users who
have logged in as administrators.
NOTE
If you select a shortcut number already registered, the currently registered shortcut can
be replaced with a new one. Some shortcuts are preregistered at the factory (example:
"ID Card Copy" of copy function).
5 Select [Save].
The shortcut is registered.
5-14
Operation on the Machine > Registering Shortcuts
To edit a shortcut
1 Select [Edit].
To delete
1 Select [Delete].
3 Select [Yes].
5-15
Operation on the Machine > Copying
Copying
Basic Operation
Follow the steps as below for basic copying.
NOTE
This function allows you to reserve the next job during printing. Using this function, the
original will be scanned while the machine is printing. When the current print job ends, the
reserved copy job is printed. If "Reserve Next Priority" is set to [Off], [Reserve Next] will
appear. Select [Reserve Next] and configure the necessary settings for the copy job.
Reserve Next Priority (page 8-20)
Copying... 10:10
Job No.:0005 Job Name:doc00000320101010101010
Scanned Pages Copies
Cancel Reserve
Next
5-16
Operation on the Machine > Copying
Canceling Jobs
You can also cancel jobs by selecting the [Stop] key.
2 Cancel a job.
NOTE
If "Reserve Next Priority" is set to [Off], the Copying screen appears in the touch panel. In such case, selecting the [Stop]
key or [Cancel] will cancel the printing job in progress.
Reserve Next Priority (page 8-20)
5-17
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Sending
This machine can send a scanned image as an attachment of an E-mail message or to a PC linked to the network. In
order to do this, it is necessary to register the sender and destination (recipient) address on the network.
A network environment which enables the machine to connect to a mail server is required in order to send E-mail. It is
recommended that a Local Area Network (LAN) be used to assist with transmission speed and security issues.
Follow the steps below for basic sending. The following four options are available.
• Send as E-mail (E-mail Addr Entry): Sends a scanned original image as an E-mail attachment. (Refer to page 5-20
and page 5-22.)
• Send to Folder (SMB): Stores a scanned original image in a shared folder of any PC. (Refer to page 5-19.)
• Send to Folder (FTP): Stores a scanned original image in a folder of an FTP server. (Refer to page 5-19.)
• Image Data Scanning with TWAIN / WIA: Scan the document using a TWAIN or WIA compatible application program.
(Refer to page 5-32.)
NOTE
• Different sending options can be specified in combination.
Sending to Different Types of Destinations (Multi Sending) (page 5-28)
• The fax function can be used on products equipped with fax capability.
FAX Operation Guide
5-18
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Basic Operation
5-19
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Specifying Destination
Select the destination using either of the following methods:
Choosing from the Address Book (page 5-20)
NOTE
• You can set the machine up so that the address book screen appears when you select the [Send] key.
Default Screen (page 8-21)
• If you are using the products equipped with the fax function, you can specify the fax destination. Enter the other
party number using the numeric keypad.
NOTE
For details on the External Address Book, refer to the following:
Command Center RX User Guide
NOTE
To deselect, select the checkbox again and remove the checkmark.
5-20
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Destination Search
Destinations registered in the Address Book can be searched.
10:10
NOTE
You can specify a destination by address number by selecting the [Quick No. Search] key.
NOTE
You can set the default "Sort" settings.
Sort (page 8-23)
5-21
Operation on the Machine > Sending
NOTE
This procedure assumes that One Touch Keys have already been registered.
For more information on adding One Touch keys, refer to the following:
Adding a Destination on One Touch Key (One Touch Key) (page 3-33)
NOTE
You can specify a One Touch Key by one touch number by selecting the [Quick No.
Search] key.
NOTE
To send an E-mail, configure the environment settings necessary.
E-mail Settings (page 2-59)
5-22
Operation on the Machine > Sending
NOTE
• For the method for setting a shared folder destination on a PC, refer to the following:
Preparation for Sending a Document to a Shared Folder in a PC (page 3-18)
• For details on how to share a folder, refer to the following:
Creating a Shared Folder, Making a Note of a Shared Folder (page 3-20)
• Be sure that SMB Protocol or FTP is On.
Protocol Settings (page 8-31)
5-23
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Login User Name If the computer name and domain name are the same: Up to
User Name 64 characters
For example: james.smith
If the computer name and domain name are different:
Domain name\User name
For example: abcdnet\james.smith
*1 When the FTP server is based on Linux/UNIX, the path including the sub-folder is combined by the
slash "/" not using the back-slash.
6 Select [OK].
Destinations can be changed later.
Checking and Editing Destinations (page 5-25)
5-24
Operation on the Machine > Sending
2 Select [Check].
To display details for the destinations, select [ ]. New E-mail addresses and PC folders can
be edited if they have been specified.
NOTE
• When selecting [On] for Entry Check for New Destination, the confirmation screen
appears. Enter the same host name and path again, and select [OK].
Entry Check for New Dest. (page 8-21)
• When selecting [On] for Destination Check before Send, the confirmation screen appears
after pressing the [Start] key.
Dest. Check before Send (page 8-21)
Confirmation Screen of Destinations (page 5-26)
5-25
Operation on the Machine > Sending
A OFFICE 1234567890
B OFFICE 2345678901
1/2
C OFFICE 3456789012
D OFFICE 4567890123
To delete the destination, select the destination you want to delete > [ ] > [Yes]
To add the destination, select [Cancel] and then return to the destination screen.
2 Select [Check].
NOTE
Be sure to confirm all destination by displaying them on the touch panel. You cannot
select [Check] unless you have confirmed all destination.
5-26
Operation on the Machine > Sending
Recall
Recall is a function allowing you to send the last entered destination once again. When you want to send the image to
the same destination, select [Recall], and you can call the destination you sent on the destination list.
1 Select [Recall].
The destination you sent is displayed on the destination list.
NOTE
When the last sending included FAX, computers and E-mail destinations, they are also
displayed. If necessary, add or delete the destination.
NOTE
• When [On] is selected in "Dest. Check before Send", a destination confirmation screen
is displayed when you press the [Start] key.
Confirmation Screen of Destinations (page 5-26)
• Recall information is canceled in the following conditions.
- When you turn the power off
- When you send a next image (new recall information is registered)
- When you log out
Send to Me (E-mail)
When user login is enabled, the document is sent to the E-mail address of the logged in user.
NOTE
• To use this function, the function icon must be displayed in the home screen.
Editing the Home Screen (page 2-14)
• An E-mail address must be set in user login for the user who logs in.
Adding a User (Local User List) (page 9-6)
5-27
Operation on the Machine > Sending
NOTE
If the destinations include a fax, the images sent to all destinations will be black and white.
5-28
Operation on the Machine > Sending
2 Cancel a job.
NOTE
Selecting the [Stop] key will not temporarily stop a job that you have already started sending.
5-29
Operation on the Machine > Sending
WSD Scan
WSD Scan saves images of originals scanned on this machine as files on a WSD-compatible computer.
NOTE
• To use WSD Scan, confirm that the computer used for WSD scanning and the machine is network-connected, and
"WSD Scan" is set to [On] in the network settings.
WSD Scan (page 8-32)
• For information on operating the computer, refer to the computer's help or the operation guide of your software.
NOTE
When [Network] does not appear in the Start menu, perform the following procedure.
2 Select the [[Start] menu] tab in the "Task bar and [Start] menu properties" screen, and
click [Customize].
3 When the "Customize [Start] menu" screen appears, select the "Network" check box
and click [OK].
NOTE
If the "User Account Control" window appears, click [Continue].
If the "Found New Hardware" window appears, click [Cancel].
During the installation, double-click the icon shown on the task bar to display the "Driver
Software Installation" screen. When "Your devices are ready to use" is displayed on the
[Driver Software Installation] screen, the installation is completed.
5-30
Operation on the Machine > Sending
WSD scan
5-31
Operation on the Machine > Sending
2 Select the machine using the application and display the dialog box.
NOTE
For selecting the machine, see the Operation Guide or Help for each application
software.
NOTE
For the settings, refer to Help in the dialog box.
5-32
Operation on the Machine > Sending
NOTE
• To use this function, you must install File Management Utility on your computer and configure settings for the
multifunction machine to be used, scanning conditions, and the file save location. To install File Management Utility,
refer to the following:
Installing Software (page 2-37)
• For information on using File Management Utility, refer to the following:
File Management Utility User Guide
3 Recall a favorite.
1 Select [Favorites] on the Home screen, or the key of the registered favorite.
If you selected the key of the favorite registered with FMU, the favorite is activated. If you selected
[Favorites], proceed to the next step.
5 When the scan settings screen appears, press each item and
configure the necessary settings.
The features that can be set depend on File Management Utility.
5-33
Operation on the Machine > Using fax server to send a fax (fax server transmission)
NOTE
To use this function, you must have a fax server. For information on your fax server, ask your administrator.
4 Specifying destination.
Entering the destination fax number with the numeric keys
NOTE
Use the numeric keys to enter a number.
3 Select [OK].
Destinations can be changed later.
Confirmation Screen of Destinations (page 5-26)
5-34
Operation on the Machine > Using fax server to send a fax (fax server transmission)
3 Select [OK].
Destinations can be changed later.
Confirmation Screen of Destinations (page 5-26)
NOTE
This function is displayed when the fax function is available on the machine.
3 Select [OK].
Destinations can be changed later.
Confirmation Screen of Destinations (page 5-26)
NOTE
For details on the External Address Book, refer to the following:
Command Center RX User Guide
5-35
Operation on the Machine > How to use the FAX Function
5-36
Operation on the Machine > What is Document Box?
NOTE
To use Custom Box, an optional SSD must be installed in the machine.
Job Box
This is a box to save jobs executed from a PC.
NOTE
• You can set up the machine so that temporary documents in job boxes are automatically deleted.
Deletion of Job Retention (page 8-22)
• For details on operating the Job Box, refer to the following:
Printing Data Saved on the Printer (page 4-12)
NOTE
When you attempt to store documents in excess of the above maximum, the oldest document data will be overwritten
by the latest document data.
The Proof and Hold feature produces only a single proof print of multiple-print job and holds printing of the remaining
copies. Printing a multiple-print job in Proof and Hold using the printer driver allows only a single copy to be printed while
maintaining the document data in the Job Box. To continue to print the remaining copies, use the operation panel. You
can change the number of copies to print.
5-37
Operation on the Machine > Basic Operation for Document Box
NOTE
In the following explanation, it is assumed that user login administration is enabled. For details on User Logon
privileges, refer to the following:
Editing and Deleting Custom Box (page 5-41)
NOTE
• You can select multiple documents by pressing the respective document checkboxes.
5-38
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
The operation on Custom Box you perform from operation panel can also be made using Command Center RX.
Command Center RX User Guide
NOTE
• To use Custom Box, an optional SSD must be installed in the machine.
• If user login administration is enabled, you can only change the settings by logging in with administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
• If user login administration is enabled, log in with administrator privileges to perform the following operations. They
cannot be performed with user privileges.
- Creating a box
- Deleting a box of which owner is another user.
5-39
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
Item Description
Box Name Enter a box name consisting of up to 32 characters.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
Box No. Enter the box number by selecting [+], [-] or number keys. The box number can
be from 0001 to 1000. A Custom Box should have a unique number. If you enter
0000, the smallest number available will be automatically assigned.
Owner*1 Set the owner of the box. Select the owner from the user list that appears.
Box Password User access to the box can be restricted by specifying a password to protect the
box. Entering a password is not mandatory. Enter the same password of up to
16 characters in both [Password] and [Confirm Password].
This can be set if [Shared] is selected in Permission.
Usage The usage for a box can be restricted. To enable a capacity restriction enter a
Restriction value for the storage capacity of the Custom Box in megabytes by selecting [-],
[+] or number keys. You can enter a limit between 1 and 30,000 (MB).
Auto File Automatically deletes stored documents after a set period of time. Select [On] to
Deletion enable automatic deletion and then use [+] and [-] or the numeric keys to enter
the number of days for which documents are stored. You can enter any number
between 1 and 31 (day(s)). To disable automatic file deletion, select [Off].
Overwrite Specifies whether or not old stored documents are overwritten when new
Setting documents are stored. To overwrite old documents, select [Permit]. To retain
old documents, select [Prohibit].
Delete after Automatically delete a document from the box once printing is complete. To
Printed delete the document, select [On]. To retain the document, select [Off].
3 Select [Save].
The Custom Box is created.
5-40
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
To edit
NOTE
• When you have logged in as a user, you can only edit a box whose owner is set to that
user.
• When you have logged in as administrator, you can edit all boxes.
When user login administration is enabled, the settings that can be changed varies depending on the
privileges of the logged in user.
Box No.
Owner
Permission
Box Password
Usage Restriction
Overwrite Setting
Box Password
Permission
Overwrite Setting
5-41
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
To delete
NOTE
• When you have logged in as a user, you can only delete a box whose owner is set to
that user.
• When you have logged in as administrator, you can edit all boxes.
3 Select [Yes].
5-42
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
NOTE
If the box to which the document is being moved is protected by a password, enter the
correct password.
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
5-43
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
If the box to which the document is being copied is protected by a password, enter the
correct password.
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
5-44
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
You can only join a document to other documents in the same custom box. If necessary, move the documents to be
joined beforehand.
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
2 Arrange the documents in the order they will be joined. > [Menu] > [Join] > [OK]
Highlight the document you want to move and then use [Cancel] and [Clear]] to move it.
3 Enter the name for the joined document > [Next >]
Enter up to 64 characters as the document name.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
4 Select [Yes].
The documents are joined.
NOTE
After joining, the original documents are left unchanged. Delete the documents if they
are no longer needed.
5-45
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
• You cannot select [ ] without first selecting a document.
• To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
2 [ ] > [Yes]
The document is deleted.
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
NOTE
To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
2 Select [Print].
5-46
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
If a custom box is protected by a password, enter the correct password.
2 Send Start.
1 Select the document in the list that you want to send by selecting its checkbox.
The document is marked with a checkmark.
NOTE
• You cannot select and send multiple documents.
• To cancel a selection, select the checkbox again so that it is no longer ticked.
NOTE
Depending on the settings, the address book screen may appear.
NOTE
For information about registering a shortcut or recalling a favorite, refer to the information
below.
Registering Shortcuts (page 5-14)
Favorites (page 5-6)
5-47
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
When this function is used, functions other than transmission cannot be used.
Before using this function, the following are necessary.
• The function icon must be displayed in the home screen.
Editing the Home Screen (page 2-14)
• An E-mail address must be set in user login for the user who logs in.
Adding a User (Local User List) (page 9-6)
5-48
Operation on the Machine > Using a Custom Box
NOTE
Before sending a document, confirm that TWAIN driver is installed on a computer and the settings are configured.
Setting TWAIN Driver (page 2-47)
To read a document stored in a custom box, use the TWAIN driver setting screen to change from "Model" to a model
name that has "(Box)" appended.
2 Select the machine using the application and display the dialog box.
NOTE
For selecting the machine, see the Operation Guide or Help for each application
software.
2 Set how to display the document data. Click the [Start] button to select each item.
NOTE
For the settings, refer to Help in the dialog box.
NOTE
In this case, the scanned page or the selected document data will not be deleted from
the Custom Box.
5-49
Operation on the Machine > Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Memory
2 When the machine reads the USB memory, "Removable Memory is recognized. Displaying
files. Are you sure?" may appear. Select [Yes].
Displays the removable memory screen.
IMPORTANT
Use USB memory properly formatted by this machine. If a USB memory formatted
by any other device is used, "The removable memory is not formatted." may
appear.
To format the USB memory, refer to the following:
Device/Communication (page 7-11)
NOTE
If the message does not appear, select [Removable Memory] on the Home screen.
5-50
Operation on the Machine > Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Memory
NOTE
• 1,000 documents can be displayed.
• To return to a higher level folder, select [Back].
5-51
Operation on the Machine > Saving Documents to USB Memory (Scan to USB)
NOTE
The maximum number of the storable files is 1,000.
2 When the machine reads the USB memory, "Removable Memory is recognized. Displaying
files. Are you sure?" may appear. Select [Yes] to display the removable memory screen.
IMPORTANT
• Use USB memory properly formatted by this machine. If a USB memory
formatted by any other device is used, "The removable memory is not
formatted." may appear.
To format the USB memory, refer to the following:
Device/Communication (page 7-11)
• When [Format] is selected, all data in the external media is erased.
NOTE
If the message does not appear, select [Removable Memory] on the Home screen.
5-52
Operation on the Machine > Check the USB Memory Information
2 Select [ ].
11-3-3.JPG
7-9-2.JPG
1/1
5-53
Operation on the Machine > Removing USB Memory
IMPORTANT
Be sure to follow the proper procedure to avoid damaging the data or USB memory.
NOTE
USB memory can also be removed after checking the status of the device.
Device/Communication (page 7-11)
5-54
Operation on the Machine > Using the Manual Stapler (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only)
NOTE
If the machine is out of staples, add more staples.
Replacing Staples (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) (page 10-12)
1 Straighten the edges of the stack of paper, and with the front
side facing up, insert the paper into the manual stapler.
When the paper is inserted all the way in, stapling takes place.
NOTE
Manual stapling cannot be used while the machine is in sleep mode.
To use manual stapling, select the [Energy Saver] key.
5-55
6 Using Various Functions
This chapter explains the following topics:
Functions Available on the Machine .................................................................................................................. 6-2
Copy ........................................................................................................................................................ 6-2
Send ........................................................................................................................................................ 6-4
Custom Box (Store File, Printing Documents, Sending Documents) ....................................................... 6-6
Removable Memory (Store File, Printing Documents) ............................................................................. 6-8
Functions ......................................................................................................................................................... 6-10
ID Card Copy ......................................................................................................................................... 6-10
Original Size .......................................................................................................................................... 6-10
Paper Selection ..................................................................................................................................... 6-11
Original Orientation ................................................................................................................................ 6-12
Mixed Size Originals .............................................................................................................................. 6-13
Collate .................................................................................................................................................... 6-13
Density ................................................................................................................................................... 6-13
Original Image ....................................................................................................................................... 6-14
EcoPrint ................................................................................................................................................. 6-15
Color Selection ...................................................................................................................................... 6-15
Sharpness .............................................................................................................................................. 6-16
Contrast ................................................................................................................................................. 6-16
Background Density Adj. (Background Density Adjustment) ................................................................. 6-17
Prevent Bleed-thrugh ............................................................................................................................. 6-17
Zoom ...................................................................................................................................................... 6-18
Combine ................................................................................................................................................ 6-20
Duplex .................................................................................................................................................... 6-22
Continuous Scan ................................................................................................................................... 6-24
Job Finish Notice ................................................................................................................................... 6-24
File Name Entry ..................................................................................................................................... 6-25
Priority Override ..................................................................................................................................... 6-25
Quiet Mode ............................................................................................................................................ 6-25
Skip Blank Page .................................................................................................................................... 6-26
Duplex (2-sided Original) ....................................................................................................................... 6-27
Sending Size .......................................................................................................................................... 6-28
File Format ............................................................................................................................................. 6-29
File Separation ....................................................................................................................................... 6-33
Scan Resolution, Resolution .................................................................................................................. 6-33
E-mail Subject/Body .............................................................................................................................. 6-33
Long Original ......................................................................................................................................... 6-34
FTP Encrypted TX ................................................................................................................................. 6-34
Delete after Printed ................................................................................................................................ 6-34
Delete after Transmitted ........................................................................................................................ 6-34
Storing Size ........................................................................................................................................... 6-35
Encrypted PDF Password ...................................................................................................................... 6-35
JPEG/TIFF Print .................................................................................................................................... 6-36
XPS Fit to Page ..................................................................................................................................... 6-36
6-1
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Reference
Function key Description
page
Paper Selection Select the cassette or multi-purpose tray that contains the required paper size. page 6-11
Zoom Adjust the zoom to reduce or enlarge the image. page 6-18
Duplex Produces two-sided copies. You can also create single-sided copies from two-sided page 6-22
originals.
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
Reference
Functions Description
page
Collate Prints ordered sets of the copies. page 6-13
ID Card Copy Use this when you want to copy a driver's license or an insurance card. When you page 6-10
scan the front and back of the card, both sides will be combined and copied onto a
single sheet.
Original Orientation Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan correct direction. page 6-12
Mixed Size Originals Scans all sheets in the document processor, even if they are of different sizes. page 6-13
Original Image Select original image type for best results. page 6-14
Contrast You can adjust the contrast between light and dark areas of the image. page 6-16
Background Density Removes dark background from originals, such as newspapers. page 6-17
Adj.
Prevent Bleed-thrugh Hides background colors and image bleed-through when scanning thin original. page 6-17
Skip Blank Page When there are blank pages in a scanned document, this function skips the blank page 6-26
pages and prints only pages that are not blank.
6-2
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Reference
Functions Description
page
Continuous Scan Scans a large number of originals in separate batches and then produce as one job. page 6-24
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
Priority Override Suspends the current job and gives a new job top priority. page 6-25
6-3
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Send
To configure the settings for functions, select [Functions].
Quiet Mode
Off
One Touch Key Address Book Ext Address Book 1/7
File Format
1/2
PDF
Original Size
E-mail Folder FAX 1-sided
Reference
Functions Description
page
Color Selection Select the color mode setting. page 6-15
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
File Format Specify the image file format. Image quality level can also be adjusted. page 6-29
Original Orientation Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan correct direction. page 6-12
Mixed Size Originals Scans all sheets in the document processor, even if they are of different sizes. page 6-13
Duplex Select the type and orientation of the binding based on the original. page 6-27
File Separation Creates several files by dividing scanned original data page by page, and sends page 6-33
the files.
Original Image Select original image type for best results. page 6-14
Contrast You can adjust the contrast between light and dark areas of the image. page 6-16
Background Density Removes dark background from originals, such as newspapers. page 6-17
Adj.
Prevent Bleed-thrugh Hides background colors and image bleed-through when scanning thin original. page 6-17
Skip Blank Page When there are blank pages in a scanned document, this function skips the blank page 6-26
pages and prints only pages that are not blank.
FAX TX Resolution Select fineness of images when sending FAX. Refer to the FAX
Operation
Guide.
Zoom Adjust the zoom to reduce or enlarge the image. page 6-18
Continuous Scan Scans a large number of originals in separate batches and then produce as one page 6-24
job.
E-mail Subject/Body Adds subject and body when sending a document. page 6-33
6-4
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Reference
Functions Description
page
Long Original Reads long-sized original documents using a document processor. page 6-34
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
FTP Encrypted TX Encrypts images when sending via FTP. page 6-34
FAX Direct Sends FAX directly without reading original data into memory. Refer to the FAX
Transmission Operation
Guide.
FAX Polling RX Automatically makes a machine with a stored document send the document to Refer to the FAX
your machine. Operation
Guide.
FAX TX Report Prints a report when transmission of a document is successful, or when an error Refer to the FAX
occurs and transmission fails. Operation
Guide.
6-5
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Ready to print from Box. 10:10 Ready to print from Box. 10:10
Print Copies Functions
Priority Override
Paper Collate Duplex Off
Selection File Name Entry
A4 Off 1-sided>>1-sided doc
Function Job Finish Notice
1/1
Store File
Reference
Function key Description
page
Duplex Select the type and orientation of the binding based on the original. page 6-27
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
Reference
Functions Description
page
Original Size Specify the original size to be scanned. page 6-10
Original Orientation Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan correct direction. page 6-12
Mixed Size Originals Scans all sheets in the document processor, even if they are of different sizes. page 6-13
Original Image Select original image type for best results. page 6-14
Contrast You can adjust the contrast between light and dark areas of the image. page 6-16
Background Density Removes dark background from originals, such as newspapers. page 6-17
Adj.
Prevent Bleed-thrugh Hides background colors and image bleed-through when scanning thin original. page 6-17
Skip Blank Page When there are blank pages in a scanned document, this function skips the blank page 6-26
pages and prints only pages that are not blank.
Zoom Adjust the zoom to reduce or enlarge the image. page 6-18
Continuous Scan Scans a large number of originals in separate batches and then produce as one job. page 6-24
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
6-6
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Printing Documents
Reference
Function key Description
page
Paper Selection Select the cassette or multi-purpose tray that contains the required paper size. page 6-11
Delete after Printed Automatically deletes a document from the box once printing is complete. page 6-34
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
Reference
Functions Description
page
Priority Override Suspends the current job and gives a new job top priority. page 6-25
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
Sending Documents
Reference
Functions Description
page
File Format Specify the image file format. Image quality level can also be adjusted. page 6-29
File Separation Creates several files by dividing scanned original data page by page, and sends page 6-33
the files.
FAX TX Resolution Select fineness of images when sending FAX. Refer to the FAX
Operation
Guide.
E-mail Subject/Body Adds subject and body when sending a document. page 6-33
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
FTP Encrypted TX Encrypts images when sending via FTP. page 6-34
FAX TX Report Prints a report when transmission of a document is successful, or when an error Refer to the FAX
occurs and transmission fails. Operation
Guide.
Delete after Transmitted Automatically deletes a document from the box once transmission is complete. page 6-34
6-7
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Ready to store in Box. (FullColor) 10:10 Ready to store in Box. (FullColor) 10:10
Store File Functions
Quiet Mode
File Duplex Scan Off
Format Resolution Original Size
PDF 1-sided 300x300dpi A4
Function Original Orientation
1/4
Store File
Reference
Function key Description
page
File Format Specify the image file format. Image quality level can also be adjusted. page 6-29
Duplex Select the type and orientation of the binding based on the original. page 6-27
Reference
Functions Description
page
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
Original Orientation Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan correct direction. page 6-12
Mixed Size Originals Scans all sheets in the document processor, even if they are of different sizes. page 6-13
Original Image Select original image type for best results. page 6-14
Contrast You can adjust the contrast between light and dark areas of the image. page 6-16
Background Density Removes dark background from originals, such as newspapers. page 6-17
Adj.
Prevent Bleed-thrugh Hides background colors and image bleed-through when scanning thin original. page 6-17
Skip Blank Page When there are blank pages in a scanned document, this function skips the blank page 6-26
pages and prints only pages that are not blank.
Zoom Adjust the zoom to reduce or enlarge the image. page 6-18
Continuous Scan Scans a large number of originals in separate batches and then produce as one job. page 6-24
Long Original Reads long-sized original documents using a document processor. page 6-34
6-8
Using Various Functions > Functions Available on the Machine
Reference
Functions Description
page
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
File Separation Creates several files by dividing scanned original data page by page, and sends the page 6-33
files.
Printing Documents
Reference
Function key Description
page
Paper Selection Select the cassette or multi-purpose tray that contains the required paper size. page 6-11
Quiet Mode Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing. page 6-25
Reference
Functions Description
page
EcoPrint EcoPrint saves toner when printing. page 6-15
Job Finish Notice Sends E-mail notice when a job is complete. page 6-24
Priority Override Suspends the current job and gives a new job top priority. page 6-25
Encrypted PDF Enter the preassigned password to print the PDF data. page 6-35
Password
JPEG/TIFF Print Select the image size when printing JPEG or TIFF files. page 6-36
XPS Fit to Page Reduces or enlarges the image size to fit to the selected paper size when printing page 6-36
XPS file.
6-9
Using Various Functions > Functions
Functions
On pages that explain a convenient function, the modes in which that function can be used are indicated by icons.
Scan to
Storing: Scan to
Box USB
ID Card Copy
Copy
Use this when you want to copy a driver's license or an insurance card. When you scan the front and back of the card,
both sides will be combined and copied onto a single sheet.
(Value: [Off] / [On])
Original Size
Metric A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Others 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6, Select from special standard sizes and
Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, custom sizes.
Hagaki (Cardstock), OufukuHagaki (Return postcard),
Youkei 4, Youkei 2, Custom*1
*1 For instructions on how to specify the custom original size, refer to the following:
Custom Original Size (page 8-11)
NOTE
Be sure to always specify the original size when using custom size original.
6-10
Using Various Functions > Functions
Paper Selection
Select the cassette or multi-purpose tray that contains the required paper size.
Select from [1] (Cassette 1) to [5] (Cassette 5) to use the paper contained in that cassette.
If [Auto] is selected, the paper matching the size of the original is selected automatically.
NOTE
• Specify in advance the size and type of the paper loaded in the cassette.
Cassette/MP Tray Settings (page 8-8)
• Cassettes 2 to 5 are displayed when the optional paper feeder is installed.
To select [MP tray], select [Paper Size] and [Media Type], and specify the paper size and the media type. The available
paper sizes and media types are shown in the table below.
Metric A4, A5, A5 (Landscape)*1, A6*1, B5, B6*1, Folio, Select from the Metric standard sizes.
216 × 340 mm
Others 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Select from special standard sizes and custom
Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL*1, sizes.
Envelope C5, Hagaki (Cardstock),
OufukuHagaki (Return postcard)*1, Youkei 4,
Youkei 2, Custom*2
Size Entry Metric Enter the size not included in the standard size.*3
X: 70 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments) When you have selected [Size Entry], use [+]/[-]
Y: 148 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments) or the numeric keys to set the sizes of "X"
(horizontal) and "Y" (vertical).
Inch
X: 2.76 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
Media type Plain (60 to 105 g/m2), Transparency, Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled, Preprinted*4, Bond,
Cardstock, Color, Prepunched*4, Letterhead*4, Envelope, Thick (106 to 220 g/m2), High Quality,
Custom 1-8*4
*1 Only for ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn, the paper can be loaded in cassette 1.
*2 For instructions on how to specify the custom paper size, refer to the following:
Custom Paper Size (page 8-12)
*3 The input units can be changed in System Menu. For details, refer to the following:
Measurement (page 8-18)
*4 For instructions on how to specify the custom paper types 1 to 8, refer to the following:
Media Type Setting (page 8-14)
To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead, refer to the following:
Special Paper Action (page 8-13)
NOTE
• You can conveniently select in advance the size and type of paper that will be used often and set them as default.
Multi Purpose Tray (page 8-9)
• If the specified size of paper is not loaded in the paper source cassette or multi purpose tray, a confirmation screen
appears. Load the required paper in the multi purpose tray and select [Continue] to start copying.
6-11
Using Various Functions > Functions
Original Orientation
Copy Send Scan to Scan to
Box USB
Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan correct direction.
To use any of the following functions, the document's original orientation must be set.
• Duplex
• Combine
• Duplex (2-sided Original)
Select original orientation from [Top Edge on Top], [Top Edge on Left] or [Auto].
Item Image
Top Edge on Top
Auto*1
*1 Displayed only when the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed.
For Copying, this does not displayed if the optional expansion memory is not installed.
NOTE
The default setting for Original Orientation can be changed.
Original Orientation (Copy) (page 8-15)
6-12
Using Various Functions > Functions
Scans all sheets in the document processor, even if they are of different sizes.
(Value: [Off] / [On])
Collate
Density
Adjust density.
Adjust density selecting [-4] (Lighter) to [+4] (Darker).
6-13
Using Various Functions > Functions
Original Image
Copying/Printing
Item Description
Text+Photo*1 Best for mixed text and photo documents.
Others Original Image Text+Photo Select to bring out text and markings made with a highlighter pen.
Reproduces the color of the highlighter pen to the extent possible.
Photo
Text
Graphic/Map
Highlighter
*1 If gray text is not printed completely using [Text + Photo], selecting [Text] may improve the result.
*2 This function is displayed while copying.
Sending/Storing
Item Description
Text+Photo Best for mixed text and photo documents.
Light Text/Fine Line Clearly reproduces faint characters written in pencil, etc., and thin lines on map originals or diagrams.
Text (for OCR)*1 Scanning produces an image that is suitable for OCR.
*1 This function is only available when "Color Selection" is set to [Black & White]. For details, refer to the following:
Color Selection (page 6-15)
6-14
Using Various Functions > Functions
EcoPrint
Color Selection
Item Description
Auto (Color/Gray) Automatically recognizes whether the document is color or black and white, and
scan color documents in Full Color and black and white documents in Grayscale.
Auto (Color/B & W) Automatically recognizes whether the document is color or black and white, and
scan color documents in Full Color and black and white documents in Black and
White.
6-15
Using Various Functions > Functions
Sharpness
Item Description
+1 to +3 (Sharpen) Emphasizes the image outline.
Contrast
You can adjust the contrast between light and dark areas of the image.
Item Description
+1 to +4 (Higher) Increases the sharpness of colors.
6-16
Using Various Functions > Functions
Item Description
Off Does not adjust the ground color.
Manual Select [1] to [5] (Lighter - Darker) to adjust the background density manually.
Prevent Bleed-thrugh
Hides background colors and image bleed-through when scanning thin original.
(Value: [Off] / [On])
6-17
Using Various Functions > Functions
Zoom
Copying
The following zoom options are available.
Auto
Adjusts the image to match the paper size.
A4: 141%
A5
A6: 70%
Standard Zoom
Reduces or enlarges at preset magnifications.
Model Zoom Level (Original Copy) Model Zoom Level (Original Copy)
Metric Models 400% Max. 90% Folio>>A4 Inch Models 400% Max. 78% Legal>>Letter
200% 70% 200% 64% Letter>>Statement
141% A5 >> A4 50% 129% Statement>>Letter 50%
100% 25% Min. 100% 25% Min.
Others
Reduces or enlarges at magnifications other than the Standard Zoom.
Model Zoom Level (Original Copy) Model Zoom Level (Original Copy)
Metric Models 115% B5 >> A4 78% Legal>>Letter Inch Models 141% A5 >> A4 86% A4 >> B5
86% A4 >> B5 64% Letter>>Statement 115% B5 >> A4 70% A4 >> A5
129% Statement>>Letter 90% Folio>>A4
Zoom Entry
Manually reduces or enlarges the original image in 1% increments between 25% and 400%. Use the numeric keys or
select [+] or [-] to enter the any magnification.
6-18
Using Various Functions > Functions
Sending/Storing
Item Description
100% Reproduces the original size.
NOTE
To reduce or enlarge the image, select the paper size, sending size, or storing size.
Paper Selection (page 6-11)
Sending Size (page 6-28)
Storing Size (page 6-35)
6-19
Using Various Functions > Functions
Combine
Copy
2 in 1 ― Copy the original with the default setting. For the default settings,
refer to the following:
4 in 1 ―
Function Defaults (page 8-15)
Original Top Edge on Top, Select the orientation of the original document top edge to scan
Orientation Top Edge on Left correct direction.
6-20
Using Various Functions > Functions
Layout image
Item Image
2 in 1 L to R/T to B
R to L/B to T
NOTE
• The paper sizes supported in Combine mode are A4, A5, B5, Folio, 216 × 340 mm, Letter, Legal, Statement,
Oficio II, and 16K.
• When placing the original on the platen, be sure to copy the originals in page order.
6-21
Using Various Functions > Functions
Duplex
Produces two-sided copies. You can also create single-sided copies from two-sided originals.
The following modes are available.
One-sided to Two-sided
Produces two-sided copies from one-sided originals. In case of an odd
number of originals, the back side of the last copy will be blank.
Original Copy
def B Original Left/Right to Binding Top: Images on the second sides are
rotated 180 degrees. Copies can be bound on the top edge, facing
Original Copy the same orientation when turning the pages.
Two-sided to One-sided
Copies each side of a two-sided original onto two individual sheets.
The following binding options are available.
• Binding Left/Right: Images on the second sides are not rotated.
Original Copy
• Binding Top: Images on the second sides are rotated 180 degrees.
Two-sided to Two-sided
Produces two-sided copies from two-sided originals.
NOTE
The paper sizes supported in Two-sided to Two-sided mode are A4,
B5, A5, Legal, Letter, Executive, Statement, Oficio II, 216 × 340 mm,
Original Copy
Folio, ISO B5, and 16K.
6-22
Using Various Functions > Functions
Copying
Prints 1-sided originals to 2-sided, or 2-sided originals to 1-sided. Select the binding orientation for original and finished
documents.
1-sided>>2-sided ― Copy the original with the default setting. For the default
settings, refer to the following:
2-sided>>1-sided ―
Function Defaults (page 8-15)
2-sided>>2-sided ―
Original Orientation*1, *2 Top Edge on Top, Select the orientation of the original document top edge to
Top Edge on Left, scan correct direction.
Auto*3
Printing
Print a document on both sides of the paper.
Item Description
1-sided Disables the function.
2-sided Prints a 2-sided document so that the sheets are aligned properly for binding on the left
or right.
2-sided Prints a 2-sided document so that the sheets are aligned properly for binding on the top.
6-23
Using Various Functions > Functions
Continuous Scan
Scans a large number of originals in separate batches and then produce as one job.
Originals will be scanned continuously until you select [Finish Scan].
(Value: [Off] / [On])
1 11 21 1
Copy Print from Print from Send Send from Scan to Scan to
Box USB Box Box USB
NOTE
PC should be configured in advance so that E-mail can be used.
Command Center RX (page 2-53)
E-mail can be sent to a single destination.
Item Description
Off Disables the function.
6-24
Using Various Functions > Functions
Copy Print from Print from Send Send from Scan to Scan to
Box USB Box Box USB
Priority Override
Suspends the current job and gives a new job top priority.
The suspended job resumes after the other job is finished.
(Value: [Off] / [On])
NOTE
• This function is not available if current job was an override.
• Priority override may not be available depending on the status of the current print job and memory usage.
Quiet Mode
NOTE
• The processing speed will be slower than normal when in Quiet Mode.
• This cannot be used when [Prohibit] is set for "Specify for Each Job".
Specify for Each Job (page 8-49)
6-25
Using Various Functions > Functions
When there are blank pages in a scanned document, this function skips the blank pages and prints only pages that are
not blank.
Blank pages can be set as pages that include ruled lines and a small number of characters.
The machine detects blank pages, saving unnecessary printing without the need to check for blank pages in the
document.
Item Description
Off Everything, including blank pages, is scanned.
On Blank Pages + Ruled Lines Blank pages and pages that include ruled lines are judged to be blank pages.
Blank Pages Only Blank pages only are judged to be blank pages.
Blank Pages + Some Text Blank pages and pages that include a small amount of text are judged to be blank
pages.
NOTE
The originals with punched holes or originals printed on a colored substrate may not be recognized as blank pages.
6-26
Using Various Functions > Functions
Select the type and orientation of the binding based on the original.
2-sided ― Set when using a 2-sided sheet original that will be bound on
the left or right.
Original Top Edge on Top, Select the orientation of the original document top edge to
Orientation*1 Top Edge on Left scan correct direction.
Auto*2
*1 Displayed when [2-sided (Binding Left/Right)] or [2-sided (Binding Top)] is selected in "Duplex".
*2 This does not appear if the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed but expansion memory is not installed.
Sample image
Value Image
2-sided Binding Left/
Right
Binding Top
6-27
Using Various Functions > Functions
Sending Size
Send
Metric A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Inch Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II Select from the Inch series standard sizes.
Others 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Select from special standard sizes and custom
Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, sizes.
Envelope C5, Hagaki (Cardstock),
Oufukuhagaki (Return postcard), Youkei 4,
Youkei 2
Sending Size Select [Same as Original Size]. Select the desired size.
NOTE
When you specify the sending size that is different from the original size, and select the zoom of [100%], you can send
the image as the actual size (No Zoom).
6-28
Using Various Functions > Functions
File Format
Specify the image file format. Image quality level can also be adjusted.
Select the file format from [PDF], [TIFF], [JPEG], [XPS], [OpenXPS], and [High Comp. PDF].
When the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed, you can also select [Word], [Excel], or [PowerPoint].
When the color mode in scanning has been selected for Grayscale or Full Color, set the image quality.
If you selected [PDF] or [High Comp. PDF], you can specify encryption or PDF/A settings.
NOTE
If encryption is enabled, PDF/A settings cannot be specified.
6-29
Using Various Functions > Functions
Password to Edit/Print Off, On Enter the password to edit the PDF file.
Document Select [On], enter a password (up to 256 characters) and
then select [Next].
Enter the password again for confirmation, and select [OK].
When you have entered the password to edit/print
document, you can specifically limit the operation.
Printing Allowed Not Allowed, Allowed Restricts printing of the PDF file.
Changes Allowed Not Allowed Disables the change to the PDF file.
Page Layout except extracting Can change the page layout except extracting the pages of
Pages the PDF file.
Any except extracting Pages Can conduct all operations except extracting the pages of
the PDF file.
Copying of Text/Images/ Disable, Enable Restricts the copying of text and objects on the PDF file.
Others
6-30
Using Various Functions > Functions
Password to Edit/Print Off, On Enter the password to edit the PDF file.
Document Select [On], enter a password (up to 256 characters) and
then select [Next].
Enter the password again for confirmation, and select [OK].
When you have entered the password to edit/print
document, you can specifically limit the operation.
Allowed (Low Resolution only) Can print the PDF file only in low resolution.
Changes Allowed Not Allowed Disables the change to the PDF file.
Inserting/Deleting/Rotating Can only insert, delete, and rotate the pages of the PDF
Pages file.
Any except extracting Pages Can conduct all operations except extracting the pages of
the PDF file.
Copying of Text/Images/ Disable, Enable Restricts the copying of text and objects on the PDF file.
Others
6-31
Using Various Functions > Functions
Item Description
Off Do not create Searchable file.
NOTE
• This function can only be used when the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed.
Scan extension kit(A) "OCR Scan Activation Kit" (page 11-8)
• This function cannot be set when you send from the Custom Box.
• If the proper language is not selected, file creation may take a long time or the creation may fail.
The default language can be changed in System Menu.
Primary OCR Language*2 (page 8-17)
• If you do not set an original in the correct orientation, the text of the document may not be recognized as characters.
In addition, it may take some time to create the file. The original orientation is correct.
• The accuracy of the text recognition depends on the original condition. The following condition may result in
decreasing the recognition accuracy.
- Repeatedly copied documents (as copied copy)
- Received faxes (with low resolution)
- Originals with the character space too narrow or wide
- Originals with the lines on the text
- Originals with the special fonts
- Binding part of the book
- A handwritten texts
6-32
Using Various Functions > Functions
File Separation
Creates several files by dividing scanned original data page by page, and sends the files.
(Value: [Off] / [Each Page])
Select [Each Page] to set File Separation.
NOTE
A three-digit serial number such as "abc_001.pdf, abc_002.pdf..." is attached to the end of the file name.
(Value: [Use File Settings]*1 / [600 × 600dpi] / [400 × 400dpi Ultra] / [300 × 300dpi] / [200 × 400dpi Super] /
[200 × 200dpi Fine] / [200 × 100dpi Normal])
*1 Displayed when sending from the Custom Box.
NOTE
The larger the number, the better the image resolution. However, better resolution also means larger file sizes and
longer send times.
E-mail Subject/Body
NOTE
The subject can include up to 60 characters, and the body can include up to 500 characters.
6-33
Using Various Functions > Functions
Long Original
Send Scan to
USB
NOTE
• Long originals are sent in black and white or Grayscale.
• Only a single side of a long original cannot Originals of up to 915 mm / 36-1/32" long can be scanned.
• You can select resolution 300×300 dpi or less.
FTP Encrypted TX
NOTE
Click [Security Settings], and then [Network Security] in the Command Center RX. Be sure that "SSL" of Secure
Protocol Settings is "On" and one or more effective encryption are selected in Client side settings.
Command Center RX User Guide
6-34
Using Various Functions > Functions
Storing Size
Scan to Scan to
Box USB
Metric A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Inch Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II Select from the Inch series standard sizes.
Others 16K, ISO B5, Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Select from special standard sizes and custom
Envelope #6, Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, sizes.
Envelope C5, Hagaki (Cardstock),
Oufukuhagaki (Return postcard), Youkei 4,
Youkei 2
Storing Size Select [Same as Original Size]. Select the desired size.
NOTE
When you select Storing Size that is different from Original Size, and select the Zoom [100%], you can store the image
as the actual size (No Zoom).
NOTE
For details on entering the password, refer to the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
6-35
Using Various Functions > Functions
JPEG/TIFF Print
Print from
USB
Item Description
Paper Size Fits the image size to the selected paper size.
Reduces or enlarges the image size to fit to the selected paper size when printing XPS file.
(Value: [Off] / [On])
6-36
7 Status/Job Cancel
This chapter explains the following topics:
Checking Job Status .......................................................................................................................................... 7-2
Details of the Status Screens .................................................................................................................. 7-3
Checking Detailed Information of Jobs .................................................................................................... 7-7
Checking Job History ......................................................................................................................................... 7-8
Checking the Detailed Information of Histories ........................................................................................ 7-9
Sending the Log History .......................................................................................................................... 7-9
Job Operation .................................................................................................................................................. 7-10
Pause and Resumption of Jobs ............................................................................................................. 7-10
Canceling of Jobs .................................................................................................................................. 7-10
Device/Communication .................................................................................................................................... 7-11
Checking the Remaining Amount of Toner and Paper (Paper/Supplies) ......................................................... 7-13
7-1
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
7-2
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
NOTE
You can show the job statuses of all users, or only the statuses of your own jobs.
Display Status/Log (page 8-19)
This setting can also be changed from Command Center RX.
Command Center RX User Guide
doc0000892010092515... Waiting
1/1
doc0000892010092520... Waiting
2 3 4 5
Cancel Pause All Close
Print Jobs
6 7
No. Item Description
1 Job No. Acceptance No. of job
Copy job
Printer job
Job from Document Box
FAX reception
E-mail reception
Data from removable memory
Application
Report/List
4 [ ] Select this key for the job for which you wish to display detailed
information.
Checking Detailed Information of Jobs (page 7-7)
6 [Cancel] Select the job you want to cancel from the list, and select this key.
7 [Pause All Print Jobs] Pauses all the printing jobs. By selecting this key again, the printing jobs
will be resumed.
7-3
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
2 3 4 5 1/1
6 7
No. Item Description
1 Job No. Acceptance No. of job
4 [ ] Select this key for the job for which you wish to display detailed
information.
Checking Detailed Information of Jobs (page 7-7)
6 [Menu] Selecting this key displays [Priority Override]. This function allows you
to give a particular fax job priority.
Select the fax job you wish to send immediately > [Menu] >
[Priority Override]
7 [Cancel] Select the job you want to cancel from the list, and select this key.
7-4
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
2 3 4 5 1/1
Cancel Close
6
No. Item Description
1 Job No. Acceptance No. of job
4 [ ] Select this key for the job for which you wish to display detailed
information.
Checking Detailed Information of Jobs (page 7-7)
6 [Cancel] Select the job you want to cancel from the list, and select this key.
7-5
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
2 3 4 5 1/1
6 7
No. Item Description
1 Job No. Acceptance No. of job
4 [ ] Select this key for the job for which you wish to display detailed
information.
Checking Detailed Information of Jobs (page 7-7)
6 [Menu] Selecting this key displays [Start Now]. Select the job you wish to send
immediately > [Menu] > [Start Now]
7 [Cancel] Select the job you want to cancel from the list, and select this key.
7-6
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job Status
NOTE
When you have logged in as a user, you can only check your own jobs. When you have logged in as administrator,
you can check all jobs.
1/1
7-7
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job History
NOTE
• Job history is also available by Command Center RX or KYOCERA Net Viewer from the computer.
Command Center RX User Guide
KYOCERA Net Viewer User Guide
• You can show the job log of all users, or only your own job log.
Display Status/Log (page 8-19)
• This setting can also be changed from Command Center RX.
Command Center RX User Guide
7-8
Status/Job Cancel > Checking Job History
Close
NOTE
To check the information of the next/previous page, select [ ] or [ ].
7-9
Status/Job Cancel > Job Operation
Job Operation
Pause and Resumption of Jobs
Pause/resume all printing jobs in printing/waiting.
2 Select [Pause All Print Jobs] on the printing jobs status screen.
Printing is paused.
When resuming the printing of jobs that have been paused, select [Resume All Print Jobs].
Canceling of Jobs
A job in printing/waiting status can be canceled.
2 Select the job to be canceled from the list, and select [Cancel].
7-10
Status/Job Cancel > Device/Communication
Device/Communication
Configure the devices/lines installed or connected to this machine or check their status.
"Scanner"
The status of an original scanning or the error information (paper jam, opened cover, etc.) is
displayed.
"Printer"
Error information such as paper jam, out of toner, or out of paper, and status such as waiting or
printing are displayed.
"FAX"
• The information such as sending/receiving and dialing is displayed.
• Select [Line Off] to cancel a fax in sending/receiving.
FAX Operation Guide
IMPORTANT
When [Format] is selected, all data in the external media is erased.
"Optional Keyboard"
The status of the optional Optional Keyboard is displayed.
"Bluetooth Keyboard"
The status of the optional Bluetooth Keyboard is displayed.
7-11
Status/Job Cancel > Device/Communication
"Wi-Fi Direct"
Shows the connection status of Wi-Fi Direct.
"Wireless Network"
The connection status of the Wireless Network Interface Kit is displayed.
"Wi-Fi"
Shows the connection status of Wi-Fi.
"SSD"
The status of the optional SSD is displayed.
7-12
Status/Job Cancel > Checking the Remaining Amount of Toner and Paper (Paper/Supplies)
"Toner Status"
The amount of toner remaining is shown in levels. And you can check the status of waste
toner box.
"Paper Status"
You can check the size, orientation, type, and remaining amount of paper in each paper
source. The amount of paper remaining is shown in levels.
7-13
8 Setup and Registration
(System Menu)
This chapter explains the following topics:
System Menu ..................................................................................................................................................... 8-2
Operation Method .................................................................................................................................... 8-2
System Menu Settings ............................................................................................................................. 8-3
Language ................................................................................................................................................. 8-5
Report ...................................................................................................................................................... 8-5
User Property ........................................................................................................................................... 8-7
Cassette/MP Tray Settings ...................................................................................................................... 8-8
Common Settings .................................................................................................................................. 8-10
Home ..................................................................................................................................................... 8-20
Copy ...................................................................................................................................................... 8-20
Send ...................................................................................................................................................... 8-21
Document Box ....................................................................................................................................... 8-22
FAX ........................................................................................................................................................ 8-22
Application ............................................................................................................................................. 8-22
Internet ................................................................................................................................................... 8-23
Address Book/One Touch ...................................................................................................................... 8-23
User Login/Job Accounting .................................................................................................................... 8-24
Printer .................................................................................................................................................... 8-24
System/Network ..................................................................................................................................... 8-27
Date/Timer/Energy Saver ...................................................................................................................... 8-46
Adjustment/Maintenance ....................................................................................................................... 8-49
8-1
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
System Menu
Configure settings related to overall machine operation.
Operation Method
System Menu is operated as follows:
2 Select a function.
1 Displays the System Menu items.
System Menu/Counter.
System Menu
1 10:10
< Back
4
-09:00 Alaska
2 Cancel OK
3
NOTE
• In order to change settings that require administer privileges, you must log in with
administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
• If function default settings have been changed, the [Reset] key can be selected in each
function screen to immediately change the settings.
Refer to System Menu Settings on the following page and configure as needed.
8-2
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Language Select the language displayed on the touch panel. page 8-5
Print Report Configure settings for printing reports and histories. page 8-5
Counter This counts the number of pages printed or scanned. page 2-50
User Property Allows you to view information about logged in users and edit some of page 8-7
that information.
Cassette 1 (to 5) Select type of paper in Cassette 1 (to 5). page 8-8
Multi Purpose Tray Select type of paper in multi purpose tray. page 8-9
Default Screen Select the screen appearing right after start-up (default screen). page 8-10
Sound Set options for buzzer sound during the machine operations. page 8-10
Function Defaults Defaults are the values automatically set after the warm-up is completed page 8-15
or the [Reset] key is selected.
Set the defaults for available settings such as copying and sending. Setting
the frequently-used values as defaults makes subsequent jobs easier.
Preset Limit Restrict the number of copies that can be made at one time. page 8-17
Error Handling Select whether to cancel or continue the job when error has occurred. page 8-17
Measurement Select inch or metric for the unit for paper dimensions. page 8-18
Low Toner Alert Set the amount of remaining toner to notify the administrator when to page 8-18
order a toner when the toner is running low.
Keyboard Layout Change the layout of the touch panel keyboard used to enter characters. page 8-18
Optional Keyboard Type Select the type of Optional keyboard that you want to use. page 8-18
Display Status/Log Set the display method of the Status/Log. page 8-19
Show Power Off Message Select whether the confirmation message is displayed, when Power page 8-19
Switch is pressed.
Message Banner Print Set whether the confirmation screen appears before each sheet is printed page 8-20
when printing multiple banner sheets.
Function Key Assignment Configure settings for function key on the operation panel. page 8-19
8-3
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Document Box Configures settings related to the Custom Box, Job Box, Sub Address page 8-22
Box and Polling Box.
FAX Operation Guide
Internet Set the proxy for connection to the Internet from an application. page 8-23
Address Book/One Touch Configures Address Book and One Touch Key settings. page 8-23
Address Book:
Adding a Destination (Address Book) (page 3-28)
One Touch Key:
Adding a Destination on One Touch Key (One Touch Key) (page 3-
33)
Printer Printing from computers, settings are generally made on the application page 8-24
software screen. However, the following settings are available for
configuring the defaults to customize the machine.
Optional Network Configure settings for the optional Network Interface Kit or Wireless page 8-38
Network Interface Kit.
Primary Network (Client) Select the network interface to be used for the send function that this page 8-40
machine functions as a client, the network authentication and connecting
to external address book.
Interface Block Setting This allows you to protect this machine by blocking the interface with page 8-41
external devices such as USB hosts or optional interfaces.
Security Level The Security Level setting is primarily a menu option used by service —
personnel for maintenance work. There is no need for customers to use
this menu.
Restart Restart the CPU without turning the power switch off. Use this to deal with page 8-42
any unstable operation by the machine. (Same as the computer restart.)
RAM Disk Setting A RAM disk can be created and its size can be set. page 8-42
Optional Memory When optional memory is installed, select the memory allocation scheme page 8-42
based on the application in which you are using the equipment.
Data Security Configure settings for data stored in the optional SSD and machine's page 8-43
memory.
Optional Function You can use the optional applications installed on this machine. page 8-45
FAX Server Settings Configure settings for FAX Server. page 8-45
8-4
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Adjustment/Maintenance Adjust printing quality and conduct machine maintenance. page 8-49
Language
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Language]
Item Description
Language Select the language displayed on the touch panel.
Report
Print reports to check the machine settings and status.
Default settings for printing the result reports can also be configured.
Report Print
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Report] > [Report Print]
Item Description
Status Page Prints the status page, allowing you to check the information including current settings,
available memory space, and optional equipment installed.
Status Page
Font List Prints the font list, allowing you to check the font samples installed in the machine.
8-5
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Network Status Prints the network status, allowing you to check the information including network interface
firmware version, network address and protocol.
Service Status Prints the service status. More detailed information is available than on the Status Page.
Service personnel usually print the service status pages for maintenance purpose.
Accounting Report Prints the accounting report, allowing you to check the accounts that have been registered on
the machine.
Sub Address Box List Prints the report on the FAX function.
Optional Network Status Prints the optional network status, allowing you to check the information including optional
network interface firmware version, network address and protocol.
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit or Wireless Network
Interface Kit is installed.
8-6
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Send Result Report Automatically print a report of transmission result when a transmission is complete.
E-mail/Folder Automatically print a report of transmission result when E-mail or SMB/FTP transmission is
complete.
Value: Off, On, Error Only
Attach Image of
Network FAX*1 FAX Operation Guide
Canceled before Print a send result report if the job is canceled before being sent.
Sending*2 Value: Off, On
Recipient Format*2 Select the Recipient Format for the send result report.
Value: Name or Destination, Name and Destination
Job Finish Notice Setting Attaches sent images to job finish notices.
Value: Do Not Attach Image, Attach Image
Item Description
Send Log History You can also send the log history to the specified destinations manually.
Auto Sending This function automatically sends the log history to the specified destinations whenever a set
number of jobs has been logged.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
If [On] is selected, specify the number of job histories. The setting range is 1 to 16.
Destination Set the destination to which log histories are sent. Only E-mail address can be set.
Job Log Subject Set the subject automatically entered when sending log histories by E-mail.
Value: Up to 60 characters
SSFC Log Subject Enter the subject of the printed job history with IC card authentication.
Value: Up to 60 characters
Personal Information Select whether to include personal information in the job log.
Value: Include, Exclude
User Property
[System Menu/Counter] key > [User Property]
Allows you to view information about logged in users and edit some of that information.
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
8-7
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Cassette 1 (to 5)
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Cassette/MP Tray Settings] > [Cassette 1 (to 5)]
Select paper size and media type for Cassettes 1 to 5.
*1 Only set this when the size dial on the cassette is set to "Other".
*2 ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only.
*3 The custom paper sizes are set for each cassette.
Custom Paper Size (page 8-12)
*4 To change to a media type other than "Plain".
Media Type Setting (page 8-14)
When a paper weight that cannot be loaded in the cassette is set for a media type, that media type does not appear.
*5 To print on preprinted or prepunched paper or on letterhead.
Special Paper Action (page 8-13)
8-8
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Paper Size Metric Select from the Metric standard sizes.
Values: A4, A5, A5 (Landscape), A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm
8-9
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Common Settings
Configures overall machine operation.
Default Screen
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Default Screen]
Item Description
Default Screen Select the screen appearing right after start-up (default screen).
Value: Home, Copy, Send, FAX*1, Custom Box, Job Box, Removable Memory,
Sub Address Box*1, Polling Box*1, FAX Memory RX Box*1, Favorites, Status,
Application Name*2
Sound
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Sound]
Item Description
Buzzer Set options for buzzer sound during the machine operations.
Key Confirmation Emit a sound when the operation panel and touch panel keys are selected.
Value: Off, On
8-10
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Original Settings
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Original Settings]
Configure settings for originals.
Item Description
Custom Original Size Set up frequently-used custom original size.
The custom size option is displayed on the screen to select original size.
Value
Metric
X: 50 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Y: 50 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Inch
X: 1.97 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 1.97 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
X=Length, Y=Width
Horizontal
Auto Detect Original Size (DP) Select whether to automatically detect originals of the document processor.
System of Units Select metric or inch for the unit of original size detection.
Value: Metric, Inch
Legal/OficioII/ As Legal, OficioII and 216 x 340 mm are similar in size, select either one of them for automatic
216 x 340 mm detection.
Value: Legal, Oficio II, 216 x 340 mm
NOTE
When [System of Units] is set to [Metric], this function will not be displayed.
Default Original Size (Platen) Select a default size for the originals placed on the platen.
If [Off] is selected, a confirmation will be displayed before each job is processed.
Value
Off
Metric: A4, A5, A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm
Inch: Letter, Legal, Statement, Executive, Oficio II
Others: 16K
NOTE
When [Auto Detect] is set to [Off], this function will not be displayed.
8-11
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Paper Settings
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Paper Settings]
Configure settings for paper.
Item Description
Custom Paper Size Set up frequently-used custom paper size.
One custom paper size is set for each paper supply source. The custom size option is
displayed on the screen to select paper size.
Cassette 1 Size*1 Register the custom paper size to be used in Cassette 1.
Value
For ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn
Metric
X: 140 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Y: 210 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Inch
X: 5.50 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 8.25 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
For ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn
Metric
X: 105 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Y: 148 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Inch
X: 4.13 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
X=Length, Y=Width
Vertical
Cassette 2 (to 5) Size*1 Register the custom paper size to be used in Cassettes 2 to 5.
Value
Metric
X: 92 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Y: 162 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Inch
X: 3.62 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 6.38 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
MP Tray Size Register the custom paper size to be used in the multi purpose tray.
Value
Metric
X: 70 to 216 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Y: 148 to 356 mm (in 1 mm increments)
Inch
X: 2.76 to 8.50" (in 0.01" increments)
Y: 5.83 to 14.02" (in 0.01" increments)
X=Length, Y=Width
Vertical Horizontal
*1 Only set this when the size dial on the cassette is set to "Other".
8-12
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Media Type Settings Select weight for each media type.
For Custom 1-8, settings for duplex printing and media type name can be changed.
Media Type Setting (page 8-14)
Default Paper Source Select the default paper source from Cassette 1 - 5 and multi purpose tray.
Value: Cassette 1 to 5, Multipurpose Tray
NOTE
[Cassette 2] to [Cassette 5] are displayed when optional paper feeder is installed.
Media for Auto (B&W) Select a default media type for auto paper selection when [Auto] is selected of Paper
Selection. If [Plain] is selected, the paper source with plain paper loaded in the specific size is
selected. Select [All Media Types] for the paper source with any kind of paper loaded in the
specific size.
Value: All Media Types, Plain, Transparency, Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled,
Preprinted, Bond, Cardstock, Color, Prepunched, Letterhead, Envelope, Thick,
High Quality, Custom 1 to 8
Special Paper Action When printing on Prepunched, Preprint, and Letterhead, punch-holes might not be aligned or
the print direction might be upside-down depending on how originals are set and the
combination of copying functions. In such a case, select [Adjust Print Direction] to adjust the
print direction. When paper orientation is not important, select [Speed Priority].
If [Adjust Print Direction] is selected, load paper according to the steps below.
Example: copying on Letterhead
Show Paper Setup Message Set whether to display the confirmation screen for the paper setting when a new paper is set for
each cassette.
Cassette 1 (to 5)
Value: Off, On
Multipurpose Tray
NOTE
[Cassette 2] to [Cassette 5] are displayed when the optional paper feeder is installed.
8-13
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
For Custom 1-8, settings for duplex printing and media type name can be changed.
Item Description
Duplex Print Permit Duplex printing allowed.
Name Change names for Custom 1-8. Names should be not more than 16 characters. Selecting
media type at multi purpose tray, the name after change will be displayed.
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
8-14
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Function Defaults
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Function Defaults]
Item Description
File Format Select the default type of the files to be sent.
Value: PDF, High Comp. PDF, TIFF, JPEG, XPS, OpenXPS, Word, Excel, PowerPoint
NOTE
[Word], [Excel], and [PowerPoint] appear when the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is
installed.
NOTE
[Auto] does not appear if the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed but expansion
memory is not installed.
NOTE
[Auto] appears when the optional OCR Scan Activation Kit is installed.
Color Selection Select the default color mode for scanning documents.
Value: Auto (Color/Gray), Auto (Color/B & W), Full Color, Grayscale, Black & White
Original Image (Copy) Set the default original document type for copying.
Value: Text+Photo, Photo, Text, Graphic/Map
Original Image (Send/Store) Set the default original document type for sending/storing.
Value: Text+Photo, Photo, Text, Text (for OCR), Light Text/Line
NOTE
[Text (for OCR)] is only available when "Color Selection" is set to [Auto (Color/B & W)] or [Black
& White].
Prevent Bleed-through (Copy) Set the default value for preventing bleed-through (Copy).
Value: Off, On
8-15
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Skip Blank Page (Copy) Set the default Skip Blank Page (Copy) settings.
Value: Off, On
Skip Blank Page (Send/Store) Set the default Skip Blank Page (Send/Store) settings.
Value: Off, On
Zoom Select the enlarged/reduced default when paper size/sending size changed after the originals set.
Value: 100%, Auto
File Name Entry Set an automatically entered name (default) for jobs. Additional information such as Date and
Time and Job No. can also be set.
Value
File Name: Up to 32 characters can be entered.
Additional Info: None, Date and Time, Job No., [Job No.] & [Date and Time],
[Date and Time] & [Job No.]
E-mail Subject/Body Set the subject and body automatically entered (default subject and body) when sending the
scanned originals by E-mail.
Value
Subject: Up to 256 characters can be entered.
Body: Up to 500 characters can be entered.
FTP Encrypted TX Set the default value for document encryption during transmission.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
This setting is displayed when the secure protocol "SSL" setting is [On].
JPEG/TIFF Print Select the image size (resolution) when printing JPEG or TIFF file.
Value: Paper Size, Image Resolution, Print Resolution
XPS Fit to Page Set the default value for the XPS fit to page function.
Value: Off, On
8-16
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Detail Settings —
Image Quality Set the default value for the image quality adjustment range when selecting the file format with
which to send and store images.
Value: 1 Low (High Comp.), 2, 3, 4, 5 High (Low Comp.)
PDF/A Set the default value for PDF/A when selecting the file format with which to send and store
images.
Value: Off, PDF/A-1a, PDF/A-1b, PDF/A-2a, PDF/A-2b, PDF/A-2u
High Comp. PDF Image Select the default quality setting for high compressed PDF files.
Value: Compression Ratio Priority, Standard, Quality Priority
Primary OCR Set the default language of the text to be extracted. ([English] is selected as a default.)
Language*2 Select the language to extract from the options displayed on the touch panel.
Detect Items to Skip Select the default Detect Items to Skip (Copy) settings.
(Copy) Value: Blank Pages + Ruled Lines, Blank Pages Only, Blank Pages + Some Text
Detect Items to Skip Select the default Detect Items to Skip (Send/Store) settings.
(Send/Store) Value: Blank Pages + Ruled Lines, Blank Pages Only, Blank Pages + Some Text
Preset Limit
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Preset Limit]
Item Description
Preset Limit Restrict the number of copies that can be made at one time.
Value: 1 to 999 copies.
Error Handling
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Error Handling]
Select whether to cancel or continue the job when error has occurred.
Item Description
Duplexing Error Select what to do when duplex printing is not possible for the selected paper size and media type.
Value
1-sided: Printed in 1-sided
Display Error: Message to cancel printing is displayed.
Paper Mismatch Error Select what to do when the selected paper size or type does not match paper size or type
loaded in the specified paper source while printing from the computer by specifying the
cassette or multi-purpose tray.
Value
Ignore: The setting is ignored and the job is printed.
Display Error: Message to cancel printing is displayed.
8-17
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Inserted Paper Mismatch Set what to do when it is detected that the cassette paper size setting does not match the
actual paper size that is fed.
Value
Ignore: The setting is ignored and the job is printed.
Display Error: Message to cancel printing is displayed.
Multi Originals Fed*1 Set the action that is executed when two or more original sheets feed at once in the automatic
document feeder.
Value
Ignore: Scanning the originals is continued.
Display Error: Message to cancel scanning is displayed.
Measurement
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Measurement]
Item Description
Measurement Select inch or metric for the unit for paper dimensions.
Value: mm, inch
Item Description
Low Toner Alert Set the amount of remaining toner to notify the administrator when to order a toner when the
toner is running low.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
Selecting [Off] alerts you low toner when the amount of remaining toner becomes 5%.
If [On] is selected, set the amount of remaining toner to alert. The setting range is 5 to 100% (in
1% increments).
Keyboard Layout
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Keyboard Layout]
Item Description
Keyboard Layout Change the layout of the touch panel keyboard used to enter characters.
Value: QWERTY, QWERTZ, AZERTY
Item Description
Optional Keyboard Type Select the type of Optional keyboard that you want to use.
Value: US-English, US-English with Euro, French, German, UK-English
8-18
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Display Status/Log
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Display Status/Log]
Item Description
Display Status/Log Set the display method of the Status/Log.
Display Jobs Detail Value: Show All, My Jobs Only, Hide All
Status
Display Jobs Log Value: Show All, My Jobs Only, Hide All
Remote Printing
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Common Settings] > [Remote Printing]
Item Description
Remote Printing Select whether to prohibit printing that is performed without operating the machine. When
[Prohibit] is selected, a document that has been stored in the document box from the printer
driver can be printed from the machine. This prevents another person from seeing that
document.
Value: Permit, Prohibit
NOTE
If [Prohibit] is selected, printing and storing using Quick Copy and Proof and Hold functions
are disabled. Printing a received FAX is not prohibited.
Item Description
Function Key 1 Value: None, Copy, Send, FAX Server*1, FAX*2, Custom Box*3, Job Box,
Removable Memory, Sub Address Box*2, Polling Box*2, FAX Memory RX Box*2,
Function Key 2 Send to Me (E-mail), Send to Me (Folder), ID Card Copy, Paper Saving Copy,
Simple Folder Send (Destination Entry), Simple Folder Send (Address Book),
Function Key 3*2
Simple Email Send (Destination Entry), Simple Email Send (Address Book),
Application*4
NOTE
You can select the function to display by selecting [Menu] > [Narrow Down] or from the pull-
down menu, by selecting [All], [Application], [Favorites], [Others] to display the function.
Item Description
Show Power Off Message Set the mode whether display a confirmation message in power supply off.
Value: Off, On
8-19
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Message Banner Print Set whether the confirmation screen appears before each sheet is printed when printing
multiple banner sheets.
Value: Off, On
Home
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Home]
Configure settings for Home screen.
Editing the Home Screen (page 2-14)
Copy
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Copy]
Configures settings for copying functions.
Item Description
Auto Paper Selection If [Auto] is selected for Paper Selection, set the paper size selection method when the zoom
changes.
Value
Most Suitable Size: Select paper based on the current zoom and the size of the original.
Same as Original Size: Select paper that matches the size of the original, regardless the
zoom.
Auto % Priority When a paper source of different size from the original is selected, select whether automatic
zoom (reduce/zoom) is performed.
Value: Off, On
Reserve Next Priority Specify whether the default screen appears when a subsequent copy job is reserved while
printing is in progress. To have the default screen appear, select [On].
Value: Off, On
8-20
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Send
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Send]
Configures settings for sending functions.
Item Description
Dest. Check before Send When performing sending jobs, display the confirmation screen of destinations after pressing
the [Start] key.*1
Value: Off, On
Entry Check for New Dest. When adding new destination, display the entry check screen to check the entered
destination.*1
Value: Off, On
Send and Forward Set whether to send the original to another destination and store it when sending images.
NOTE
When selecting [On], select rules to forward from [FAX]*2, [E-mail], [Folder (SMB)] and
[Folder (FTP)].
Destination Set the destination to which the original is forwarded. One destination can be set. You can
check and edit the set address.
Follow the steps below to register the destination.
• Address Book
• Ext. Address Book
• Address Entry (E-mail)
• Address Entry (folder)
Specifying Destination (page 5-20)
Color TIFF Compression Select the compression method for TIFF images handled on this machine.
Value: TIFF V6, TTN2
Default Screen Use this procedure to set the default screen displayed when you select the [Send] key.
Value: Destination, Address Book, Ext. Address Book, One Touch
Recall Destination Select whether to permit usage of [Recall] on the Send screen.*1
Value: Permit, Prohibit
OCR Text Recognition Action*3 Configure settings for OCR Text Recognition Action.
Value: Speed Priority, Quality Priority
8-21
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Document Box
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Document Box]
Configures settings related to the Custom Box, Job Box, Sub Address Box and Polling Box.
Item Description
Custom Box Configure settings for Custom Box.
Quick Copy Job To maintain free space on the box, you can set the maximum number of stored jobs.
Retention Value: number between 0 and 300
NOTE
When 0 is set, Quick Copy cannot be used.
Deletion of Job This setting specifies that documents, such as Private Printing, Quick Copying, or Proof and
Retention Hold Printing, saved temporarily in the job box are automatically deleted after they have been
saved for a set time.
Value: Off, 1 hour, 4 hours, 1 day, 1 week
NOTE
This function is valid for documents saved after the function is set. Regardless of this function
setting, temporary documents are deleted when the main power switch is turned off.
NOTE
This setting is not displayed if the optional SSD or SD card is not installed.
Polling Box*1
FAX Operation Guide
FAX Memory RX Box*1
FAX
[System Menu/Counter] key > [FAX]
Configure settings for FAX.
Application
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Application]
Configure settings for Application.
Item Description
Application You can install, activate, deactivate, and uninstall applications.
Application (page 5-11)
8-22
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Internet
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Internet]
Set the proxy for connection to the Internet from an application.
Item Description
Proxy Specify the proxy settings.
Value: Off, On
Use Same Proxy Set whether or not the same proxy server is used for all protocols. If the same proxy server is
not used, select [Off].
Value: Off, On
HTTPS Proxy Server Set a proxy server (HTTPS). This setup is available when [Use Same Proxy] is [Off].
Value: (Enter the proxy address and port number.)
Item Description
Sort Select the default sort setting of the address for the address book.
Value: No., Name
Address Book Specify the default sort setting of the external address book.
8-23
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Edit Restriction
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Address Book/One Touch] > [Edit Restriction]
Item Description
Address Book Restrict editing of the address book. If you selected [Administrator Only], you can only edit
the Address Book by logging in with administrator privileges.
Value: Off, Administrator Only
One Touch Key Restrict editing of the One Touch Key. If you selected [Administrator Only], you can only edit
the One Touch Key by logging in with administrator privileges.
Value: Off, Administrator Only
Print list
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Address Book/One Touch] > [Print list]
Printer
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Printer]
Printing from computers, settings are generally made on the application software screen. However, the following
settings are available for configuring the defaults to customize the machine.
Item Description
Emulation Select the emulation for operating this machine by commands oriented to other types of
printers.
Value: Line Printer, IBM Proprinter, EPSON LQ-850, PCL6, KPDL, KPDL (Auto)
NOTE
When you have selected [KPDL (Auto)], set "Alt Emulation", too.
When you have selected [KPDL] or [KPDL (Auto)], set "KPDL Error Report", too.
Alt Emulation When you have selected [KPDL (Auto)] as emulation mode, you can switch between KPDL
and another emulation mode (alternative emulation) automatically according to the data to
print.
Value: Line Printer, IBM Proprinter, EPSON LQ-850, PCL6
KPDL Error Report When an error has occurred during printing in KPDL emulation mode, set whether or not the
error report is output.
Value: Off, On
EcoPrint EcoPrint conserves toner when printing. This is recommended for test copies where faded
printing is not a problem.
Value: Off, On
8-24
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Override A4/Letter Select whether to treat A4 size and Letter, which are similar in size, as the same size when
printing.
Value
Off: A4 and Letter are not regarded as the same in size.
On: A4 and Letter are regarded as the same in size. The machine will use whichever size
is in the paper source.
Paper Output Select either the inner tray or the optional Rear Tray for the output stack.
Value: Inner Tray Face Down, Rear Tray Face Up
NOTE
This function can be used for ECOSYS M3655idn and ECOSYS M3660idn.
Wide A4 Turn this to on to increase the maximum number of characters that can be printed in a line for
an A4 page (78 characters at 10 pitch) and Letter size page (80 characters at 10 pitch). This
setting is only effective in PCL6 emulation.
Value: Off, On
Form Feed TimeOut Receiving print data from the computer, the machine may sometimes wait if there is no
information signaling that the last page does not have any more data to be printed. When the
preset timeout passes, the machine automatically prints paper. The options are between 5 and
495 seconds.
Value: 5 to 495 seconds (in 5 second increments)
LF Action Set the line feed action when the machine receives the line feed code (character code 0AH).
Value: LF Only, LF and CR, Ignore LF
CR Action Set the character return action when the machine receives the character return code (character
code 0DH).
Value: CR Only, LF and CR, Ignore CR
Job Name Set whether the job name set in the printer driver is displayed.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
When selecting [On], select the job name to be displayed from [Job Name], [[Job No.] & [Job
Name]], or [[Job Name] & [Job No.]].
User Name Set whether the user name set in the printer driver is displayed.
Value: Off, On
MP Tray Priority If paper is set in the MP Tray then it is possible for priority to be given to that MP tray in the
paper feed.
Value
Off: The printer driver settings are followed.
Auto Feed: If Auto is selected in the printer driver and there is paper in the MP tray then
the paper feed will be from the MP tray.
Always: If there is paper in the MP tray then the paper feed will be from the MP tray
regardless of what is set in the printer driver.
8-25
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Paper Feed Mode While printing from the computer, select how to feed paper when the paper source and type are
specified.
Value
Auto: Search the paper source that matches the selected paper size and type.
Fixed: Print on paper loaded in the specified paper source.
Auto cassette Change Select the following actions when the paper runs out in the paper source while printing.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
When selecting [Off], the machine displays "Add the following paper in cassette #." (# is a
cassette number) or "Add the following paper in the multi purpose tray.", and stops printing.
Load the paper according to the paper source displayed to resume printing.
To print from the other paper cassette, select [Paper Selection]. Select the desired paper
source.
When selecting [On], the machine continues printing automatically when the other cassette
contains the same paper as the currently-used cassette.
NOTE
Settings that are received from the printer driver have priority over the operation panel settings.
Printing Job Terminator Set the condition to be regarded as the job end if the print job has not been processed to the
end due to the usage environment or for other reasons.
Value:
EOJ (End of Job): Up to the detection of a command indicating the end of job data is
regarded as one job.
End of Network Session: Data contained in one session of network connection is
regarded as one job.
UEL (Universal Exit Language): Up to detection of UEL at the end of the job is regarded
as one job.
8-26
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
System/Network
Configures machine system settings.
Network
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Network]
Configures network settings.
Host Name
Item Description
Host Name Check the host name of the machine. Host name can be changed from Command Center RX.
Changing Device Information (page 2-57)
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional Wireless Network Interface Kit is installed.
Item Description
Wi-Fi Direct Select whether to use Wi-Fi Direct.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
• Up to 32 characters can be entered.
• This function is displayed when [Wi-Fi Direct] is set to [On].
NOTE
• If you select [ON], set the waiting time for automatic disconnection.
• This function is displayed when [Wi-Fi Direct] is set to [On].
Wi-Fi Settings
Set Wi-Fi.
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional Wireless Network Interface Kit is installed.
Item Description
Wi-Fi Select whether to use Wi-Fi.
Value: Off, On
8-27
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Setup -
Quick Setup If the machine will connect to an access point that supports the automatic wireless network
setup, connection settings can be configured by Quick Setup.
NOTE
When [Reload] is selected, the list is reloaded.
If you are connecting to an access point that has WEP enabled, select [WEP Key Index] and
select the WEP key index.
Available Network Displays access points to which the machine can connect.
WEP Key Index Select the key index of the access point.
Value: 0 to 3
Push Button Method If the access point supports the push button method, wireless settings can be configured using
the push button. This setting executes push button, and the connection is started by pressing
the push button on the access point.
NOTE
The push button method supports only the WPS.
PIN Code Method Starts connection using the machine's PIN code. Enter the PIN code into the access point. The
(Device) PIN code of the machine is automatically generated.
Custom Setup The detailed settings for wireless LAN can be changed.
Network Name (SSID) Set the SSID (Service Set Identifier) of the wireless LAN to which the machine connects.
NOTE
Up to 32 characters can be entered.
Encryption Select encryption method. The setting values vary depending on the Network Authentication
setting.
Network Encryption
Authentication
Open Disable ―
8-28
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
TCP/IP Setting -
IPv4 Settings Set up TCP/IP (IPv4) to connect to the network. This setting is available when [TCP/IP] is set to
[On].
NOTE
When DHCP is set to [On], this function will be grayed out and the value cannot be entered.
NOTE
When DHCP is set to [On], this function will be grayed out and the value cannot be entered.
NOTE
When DHCP is set to [On], this function will be grayed out and the value cannot be entered.
IMPORTANT
• When setting the Auto-IP, enter "0.0.0.0" in [IP Address].
• After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
8-29
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
IPv6 Set up TCP/IP (IPv6) to connect to the network. This setting is available when [TCP/IP] is [On].
NOTE
Selecting [On] displays IP address in [IP Address (Link Local)] after restarting the network.
Manual Setting Manually specify the IP address, prefix length, and gateway address of TCP/IP (IPv6).
Value
IP Address (Manual): 128-bits address is expressed in eight groups consisting of four-
digit hexadecimal digits. The groups are separated by colon (:).
Prefix Length: 0 to 128
Default Gateway: 128-bits address is expressed in eight groups consisting of four-
digit hexadecimal digits. The groups are separated by colon (:).
NOTE
• This function is displayed when [IPv6] is set to [On].
• To enter "Default Gateway", set [RA (Stateless)] to [Off].
NOTE
• This function is displayed when [IPv6] is set to [On].
• Selecting [On] displays IP address in [IP Address (Stateless)] after restarting the network.
NOTE
• This function is displayed when [IPv6] is set to [On].
• Selecting [On] displays IP address in [IP Address (Stateful)] after restarting the network.
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
Item Description
TCP/IP Settings For details on setting value.
TCP/IP Setting (page 8-29)
LAN Interface Specify the settings for the LAN interface to be used.
Value: Auto, 10Base-Half, 10Base-Full, 100Base-Half, 100Base-Full, 1000BASE-T
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
8-30
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Bonjour
Item Description
Protocol Setting Select whether to use Bonjour.
Value: Off, On
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*1 Value: Disable, Enable
*1
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
*1 Displayed only when the wireless network function is available on the machine.
IP Filter (IPv4)
Item Description
IP Filter (IPv4) Make this setting when you use IP Filter (IPv4).
Value: Off, On
IP Filter (IPv6)
Item Description
IP Filter (IPv6) Make this setting when you use IP Filter (IPv6).
Value: Off, On
IPSec
Item Description
IPSec Make this setting when you use IPSec.
Value: Off, On
Protocol Settings
Configure protocol settings.
Item Description
NetBEUI -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-31
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
LPD -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
FTP Client (Transmission) Select whether to send documents using FTP. When selecting [On], set the FTP Port Number.
The default port number is 21.
Value: Off, On (Port Number: 1-65535)
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
SMB Client (Transmission): Select whether to send documents using SMB. When selecting [On], set the SMB default Port
Number. The default port number is 445.
Value: Off, On (Port Number: 1-65535)
WSD Scan -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
*2
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
WSD Print -
Protocol Setting Set whether to use our proprietary web services. WIA driver, TWAIN driver and Network FAX
driver use this Enhanced WSD web service.*1
Value: Off, On
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
*2
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-32
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
DSM Scan Select whether to use DSM scan.*1
Value: Off, On
SNMP -
SNMPv3 -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
HTTP -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
HTTPS -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-33
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
IPP -
Protocol Setting Selects whether to receive documents using IPP. To use the IPP protocol, select [Not Secure
(IPP&IPPS)] on IPP Security under Security Settings from the Command Center RX.*1
Value: Off, On
Port Number Set the IPP default Port Number. The default port number is 631.
Value: 1-32767
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
*2
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
NOTE
When selecting [On], it also requires a certificate for SSL. the default certificate is the self-
certificate of the machine.
Command Center RX User Guide
Port Number Set the IPP over SSL default Port Number. The default port number is 443.*1
Value: 1-32767
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
Raw Port -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-34
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
ThinPrint -
NOTE
This function is displayed only when the optional ThinPrint Option is activated.
Port Number Set the ThinPrint default Port Number. The default port number is 4000.
Value: 1-32767
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
ThinPrint over SSL To use the ThinPrint over SSL protocol, set [ThinPrint Over SSL] to [On].*1, *3
Value: Off, On
NOTE
• This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
• When selecting [On], it also requires a certificate for SSL. The default certificate is the self-
certificate of the machine.
Command Center RX User Guide
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
Enhanced WSD -
NOTE
Selecting [Off] will disable the functionality of WIA, TWAIN, and Network FAX driver.
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
*2
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
Protocol Setting Set whether to use our proprietary web services over SSL.*1, *3
Value: Off, On
NOTE
Selecting [Off] will disable the functionality of WIA, TWAIN and Network FAX drivers.
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-35
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
eSCL -
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
Protocol Setting Selects whether to receive scanned documents using eSCL over SSL.*1, *3
Value: Off, On
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
REST -
Port Number Set the REST default Port Number. The default port number is 9080.*1
Value: 1-32767
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
*2
Available Network (Wi-Fi) NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
8-36
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
REST over SSL -
Port Number Set the REST over SSL default Port Number. The default port number is 9081.*1
Value: 1-32767
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is set to [On].
Available Network Set whether to enable this function for each network.
(Wi-Fi Direct)*2 Value: Disable, Enable
Available Network (Wi-Fi)*2 NOTE
Available Network This function is displayed when [Protocol Setting] is [On] and the optional Wireless Network
(Wired Network) Interface Kit is installed.
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
Security Settings
Item Description
SSL Select whether or not to use SSL.
Value: Off, On
IPP Security Select the IPP security level. This setup is available when SSL is [On].
Value: IPP/IPP over SSL, IPPoverSSL only
HTTP Security Select the HTTP security level. This setup is available when SSL is [On].
Value: HTTP/HTTPS, HTTPS Only
SMTP Security Select the communication protocol according to the type of security employed by the SMTP
server. This setup is available when SSL is [On].
Value: Off, SSL/TLS, STARTTLS
POP3 Security (User 1) Select the communication protocol according to the type of security employed by the POP3
server. This setup is available when POP3 is [On].
POP3 Security (User 2)
Value: Off, SSL/TLS, STARTTLS
POP3 Security (User 3)
Ping
Item Description
Ping Checks if communication with the destination by entering the host name or IP address of the
destination is possible.
NOTE
If [Primary Network (Client)] is set to [Optional Network], this item is not displayed.
8-37
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Restart Network
Item Description
Restart Network Restarts the network.
Proxy
Item Description
Proxy Specify the proxy settings.
Value: Off, On
Use Same Proxy Set whether or not the same proxy server is used for all protocols. If the same proxy server is
not used, select [Off].
Value: Off, On
HTTPS Proxy Server Set a proxy server (HTTPS). This setup is available when [Use Same Proxy] is [Off].
Value: (Enter the proxy address and port number.)
Optional Network
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Optional Network]
Setup
Configure settings for the optional Wireless Network Interface Kit.
NOTE
This function is displayed when the Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-51) is installed.
Item Description
Connection Status You can check the wireless LAN status.
Quick Setup If the machine will connect to an access point that supports the automatic wireless network
setup, connection settings can be configured by Quick Setup.
Available Network Select access points to which the machine can be connected, enter the Preshared Key and
start a connection.
Push Button Method If the access point supports the push button method, wireless settings can be configured using
the push button. This setting executes push button, and the connection is started by pressing
the push button on the access point.
NOTE
The push button method supports only the WPS.
PIN Code Method Starts connection using the machine's PIN code. Enter the PIN code into the access point. The
(Device) PIN code of the machine is automatically generated.
PIN Code Method Starts connection using the PIN code of the access point. Enter the PIN code of the access
(Terminal) point.
8-38
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Custom Setup The detailed settings for wireless LAN can be changed.
Network Name (SSID) Set the SSID (Service Set Identifier) of the wireless LAN to which the machine connects.
NOTE
Up to 32 characters can be entered.
NOTE
Ad Hoc: Directly communicates with the device without going through an access point. This
method cannot be used to connect to two or more devices.
Infrastructure: Performs communication through an access point.
Channel Set channel. Use [-] / [+] or the numeric keys to enter a number.
Value: 1 to 11
Network Authentication Select network authentication type. To select other options, open the device home page from a
computer.
Value: Open, Shared, WPA-PSK*1, WPA2-PSK*1
Encryption Select encryption method. If the option other than [Disable] is selected, enter the WEP key or
the Preshared key. The setting values vary depending on the Network Authentication setting.
Select [Data Encryption].
When Network Authentication is set to [Open] or [Shared]:
Value: Disable, WEP
When Network Authentication is set to [WPA-PSK] or [WPA2-PSK]:
Value: TKIP*2, AES, Auto*2, Preshared Key
NOTE
• If [WEP] is selected, enter the WEP key. Up to 26 characters can be entered.
• If [TKIP], [AES] or [Auto] is selected, enter the Preshared key. Enter the value in 8 to 63
characters.
Basic
Configure settings for the optional Network Interface Kit.
NOTE
This menu is displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit or Wireless Network Interface Kit is installed.
Item Description
Host Name Check the host name of the machine. Host name can be changed from Command Center RX.
Changing Device Information (page 2-57)
8-39
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
LAN Interface Select the LAN Interface type.*1
Value: Auto, 10Base-Half, 10Base-Full, 100Base-Half, 100Base-Full, 1000BASE-T
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit is installed.
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit (IB-50) or Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-51 or
IB-36) is installed.
Item Description
Primary Network (Client) Select the network interface to be used for the send function that this machine
functions as a client, the network authentication and connecting to external address
book.
Value: Wi-Fi, Wired Network, Optional Network
NOTE
• [Wi-Fi] is displayed when the Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-36) is installed.
• [Optional Network] is displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit (IB-50) or
Wireless Network Interface Kit (IB-51) is installed.
• You can set and use "[Wired Network] or [Wi-Fi]", and "[Optional Network] (IB-50 or
IB-51)" individuayly for the e-mail send connection.
8-40
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
USB Host This locks and protects the USB port (USB host).
Value: Unblock, Block
USB Device This locks and protects the USB interface connector (USB Device).
Value: Unblock, Block
USB Storage This locks and protects the USB memory slot.
Value: Unblock, Block
NOTE
This function is available when USB Host is set to [Unblock].
Optional Interface This locks and protects the optional interface slots.
Value: Unblock, Block
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
Bluetooth Settings
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Bluetooth Settings]
NOTE
This function is displayed when the Bluetooth adapter is installed.
Item Description
Bluetooth Use Bluetooth keyboard.
Value: Off, On
Security Level
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Security Level]
Item Description
Security Level Specify the security level.
Value
Low: This mode is used during maintenance. Do not use normally.
High: This is the security setting we recommend. Use this setting normally.
Very High: In addition to [High] setting, this setting disables the machine settings to be
changed from external command.
8-41
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Restart
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Restart]
Item Description
Restart Restart the CPU without turning the power switch off. Use this to deal with any unstable
operation by the machine. (Same as the computer restart.)
NOTE
This function will not be displayed when the optional SSD is installed.
Item Description
RAM Disk Setting A RAM disk can be created and its size can be set.
Creating a RAM disk makes it possible to print from a Job Box.
Value
RAM Disk Setting: Off, On
RAM Disk Size: The setting range varies depending on the amount of memory installed
and the option memory usage setting.
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
Optional Memory
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Optional Memory]
Item Description
Optional Memory When optional memory is installed, select the memory allocation scheme based on the
application in which you are using the equipment.
Value: Printer Priority, Normal, Copy Priority
IMPORTANT
After changing the setting, restart the network or turn the machine OFF and then ON.
8-42
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Data Security
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Data Security]
Configure settings for data stored in the optional SSD and machine's memory.
Item Description
SSD Initialization This changes security function settings.
NOTE
• This function is displayed when the optional SSD is installed and the optional Data Security
Kit is activated.
• Input of the security password is required to change security function settings. The initial
setting for the Security Password is "000000".
Security Password You can customize the security password so that only the administrator can use the security kit.
Enter a password that uses 6 to 16 alphanumeric characters and symbols.
You will need to enter the password again for confirmation.
IMPORTANT
Avoid any easy-to-guess numbers for the security password (e.g. 11111111 or 12345678).
System Initialization This can be used to delete all the data stored in the SSD. Overwrite all the data stored in the
SSD when disposing of the machine.
IMPORTANT
If you accidentally turn the power switch off during initialization, the SSD might possibly
crash or initialization might fail.
NOTE
If you accidentally turn off power during initialization, turn it back on. Initialization will restart
automatically.
8-43
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Data Sanitization Return the following information registered in the machine to the factory defaults.
• Address Book
• Favorites
• System settings
• Fax transmission and reception / forwarding data
• Transmission histories
• Data saved in Custom Box
• Optional applications
IMPORTANT
Data saved in an application or SD card cannot be erased. To erase data on an SD card,
you must format the SD card.
NOTE
• Once in progress, the processing cannot canceled.
• Before performing this function, disconnect modular, network, and other cables.
• Before performing this function, set all interface block settings to [Unblock].
Interface Block Setting (page 8-41)
• Do not turn off the main power switch while sanitizing the data. If the main power is turned
off during data erasing, erasing will be executed automatically when the power is restored,
however, complete erasure cannot be guaranteed.
Reserve a Sanitization Completely erase address and image data saved in the device at the scheduled time.
Time Value: Off, On
If [On] is selected, set the date and time that sanitization is to be performed. The setting range
is Year (2000 to 2037), Month (1 to 12), Day (1 to 31), Hour (00 to 23).
Device Use After The device use restriction after the data sanitization is completed.
Sanitization The device cannot be used if [Prohibit] is selected.
Value: Permit, Prohibit
Item Description
OCR Dictionary Installation Install the OCR Dictionary.
NOTE
• For information on dictionary data, consult your Service Representative.
• To install the OCR dictionary, an SSD or SD/SDHC memory card must be inserted.
• If both an SSD and an SD/SDHC memory card are inserted, the OCR dictionary will be
installed on the SSD.
• If you will use an SD/SDHC memory card, a 32 GB SD/SDHC memory card is
recommended.
8-44
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Optional Function
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] > [Optional Function]
Item Description
Optional Function You can use the optional applications installed on this machine.
Optional Applications (page 11-9)
Item Description
FAX Server Select whether or not to use FAX Server.
Value: Off, On
Address Settings Set the prefix, suffix, and domain name to be assigned to the address.
NOTE
• This appears when [On] is set in fax server.
• For the fax server information, ask your fax server administrator.
NOTE
This appears when [On] is set in fax server.
NOTE
• This appears when [On] is set in fax server.
• This does not appear when extension address book is not enabled, .
Command Center RX User Guide
8-45
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Date/Timer/Energy Saver
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Date/Timer/Energy Saver]
Configures settings related to the date and time.
Item Description
Date/Time Set the date and time for the location where you use the machine. If you perform Send as E-
mail, the date and time set here will be displayed on the header.
Value: Year (2000 to 2037), Month (1 to 12), Day (1 to 31), Hour (00 to 23), Minute (00 to
59), Second (00 to 59)
Setting Date and Time (page 2-24)
NOTE
If you change the date/time while using the trial version of an application, you will no longer be
able to use the application.
Date Format Select the display format of year, month, and date. The year is displayed in Western notation.
Value: Month/Day/Year, Day/Month/Year, Year/Month/Day
Time Zone Set the time difference from GMT. Choose the nearest listed location from the list. If you select
a region that utilizes summer time, configure settings for summer time.
Auto Panel Reset If no jobs are run for a certain period of time, automatically reset settings and return to the
default setting. Select to use Auto Panel Reset or not.
Value: Off, On
NOTE
The time allowed to elapse before the panel is reset is set with the following:
Panel Reset Timer (page 8-46)
Panel Reset Timer If you select [On] for Auto Panel Reset, set the amount of time to wait before Auto Panel Reset.
Value: 5 to 495 seconds (in 5 second increments)
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Auto Panel Reset] is set to [On].
Low Power Timer Set amount of time before entering the Low Power mode.
Value
For Europe: 1 to 120 minutes (1 minute increments)
Except for Europe: 1 to 240 minutes (1 minute increments)
Low Power Mode (page 2-33)
NOTE
This function will not be displayed when the optional Network Interface Kit is installed.
Sleep Rules Select whether to use the Energy Saver mode for the following functions individually:
• Card Reader*1
• Application
Value: Off, On
NOTE
When the machine has entered sleep mode with Energy Saver setting, the ID card cannot be
recognized.
8-46
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Sleep Rules (models for Select whether to use the Sleep mode for the following functions individually:
Europe) • Card Reader*1
• Application
Value: Off, On
NOTE
If the sleep condition is not turned off, the ID card cannot be recognized.
Energy Saver Recovery Level Select the method of recovery from energy saver.
Value:
Full Recovery: This mode enables the use of all functions immediately.
However, this mode saves less energy.
Normal Recovery: In this mode, you can select the method from the following:
enabling the use of all functions immediately or enabling the
use of desired functions only.
If you want to use all functions immediately, select the [Energy
Saver] key to execute recovery.
Power Saving Recovery: This mode enables the use of desired functions only.
This mode saves energy most effectively.
Weekly Timer Settings Configure settings for switching the machine to OFF and waking it automatically at a specified
time for each day of the week.
Schedule Specify the time for each day of the week at which the machine turns OFF.
Retry Times Set the number of retries for turning OFF this machine.
Value: Limited Retries, Unlimited Retries
NOTE
If [Limited Retries] is selected, set the number of retry. The setting range is 0 to 10. Retry is
not performed when "0" is set.
If [Unlimited Retries] is selected, retry is performed until the machine turns OFF.
8-47
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Power Off Rule (models for Select whether or not the machine enters Power Off mode for the following function. Select
Europe) [On] to set the Power Off mode.
• Network
• FAX*1
• USB Cable
• USB Host
• RAM Disk
• NIC*2
• Remote Diagnostics*1
• Application
Value: Off, On
NOTE
Even when any of the functions is set to [On], if [FAX] is set to [Off], the machine does not
enter Power Off Mode.
Even when [Network] or [USB Cable] is set to [Off], if the machine does not communicate with
the other devices, the machine will enter Power Off Mode.
Power Off Timer (models for Select whether to turn off the power automatically after a period of inactivity.
Europe) Value: 1 hour, 2 hours, 3 hours, 4 hours, 5 hours, 6 hours, 9 hours, 12 hours, 1 day,
2 days, 3 days, 4 days, 5 days, 6 days, 1 week
Auto Error Clear If an error occurs during processing, processing stops to wait for the next step to be taken by
the user. In the Auto Error Clear mode, automatically clear the error after a set amount of time
elapses.
Value: Off, On
Error Clear Timer If you select [On] for Auto Error Clear, set the amount of time to wait before automatically
clearing errors.
Value: 5 to 495 seconds (in 5 second increments)
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Auto Error Clear] is set to [On].
Ping Timeout Set the time until timeout occurs when [Ping] is executed in "System/Network".
Value: 1 to 30 seconds (in 1 second increments)
NOTE
If [Primary Network (Client)] is set to [Optional Network], this item is not displayed.
8-48
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Adjustment/Maintenance
[System Menu/Counter] key > [Adjustment/Maintenance]
Adjust printing quality and conduct machine maintenance.
Item Description
Quiet Mode Settings Lower print and scan speed for quiet processing.
Quiet Mode Set the Quiet Mode. Select this mode when the running noise is uncomfortable.
Value: Off, On
Specify for Each Job It is possible to set the use of Quiet Mode for each job, such as copying and sending. Set
whether or not to permit the setting for each job.
Value: Permit, Prohibit
Send/Box Adjust scan density when sending or storing the data in Document Box.
Value: -3 (Lighter), -2, -1, 0 (Normal), +1, +2, +3 (Darker)
Copy Sharpen or blur overall image outlines during copying. Adjustment can be made in 7 levels.
Value: -3 (Blur), -2, -1, 0, +1, +2, +3 (Sharpen)
Send/Box Sharpen or blur overall image outlines when sending or storing them in the Document Box.
Adjustment can be made in 7 levels.
Value: -3 (Blur), -2, -1, 0, +1, +2, +3 (Sharpen)
Send/Box Increases or decreases the overall contrast when documents are sent or saved in a document
box.
Value: -3 (Lower), -2, -1, 0 (Normal), +1, +2, +3 (Higher)
Copy (Auto) Darkens or lightens overall background density adjustment during copying.
Value: -3 (Lighter), -2, -1, 0 (Normal), +1, +2, +3 (Darker)
Send/Box (Auto) Darkens or lightens overall background density when sending images or storing them in the
Document Box.
Value: -3 (Lighter), -2, -1, 0 (Normal), +1, +2, +3 (Darker)
Toner Save Level (EcoPrint) Select the default Toner Save Level (EcoPrint).
Copy Select the default Toner Save Level (EcoPrint) at the time of copying.
Value: 1 to 5
Raising the level reduces toner consumption, but image quality falls.
Printer Select the default Toner Save Level (EcoPrint) at the time of use of the printer.
Value: 1 to 5
Raising the level reduces toner consumption, but image quality falls.
8-49
Setup and Registration (System Menu) > System Menu
Item Description
Auto Color Correction This setting allows you to adjust the detection level used by the machine to determine whether
the original is color or black and white during Auto Color Mode. Setting a lower value will result
in more originals being identified as color, while a larger value will tend to increase the number
of originals being identified as black and white.
Value: 1 (Color), 2, 3, 4, 5 (B & W)
Correcting Black Line Correct fine lines (streaks caused by contamination), which may appear on the image, when
the document processor is used.
Value: Off, On
Drum Refresh/Drum Refresh 1 Remove image blur from the printout. It takes about 80 seconds for ECOSYS M3655idn/
ECOSYS M3660idn or 120 seconds for ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn. The time
required may vary depending on the operating environment.
Drum Refresh/Drum Refresh 1 (page 10-30)
NOTE
Drum Refresh/Drum Refresh 1 cannot be performed while printing. Execute Drum Refresh/
Drum Refresh 1 after the printing is done.
Drum Refresh 2 Remove white dots from the printout. It takes about 80 seconds. To use [Drum Refresh 2], load
A4 or Letter size paper into the Multipurpose tray.
When you run [Drum Refresh 2], the machine sometimes makes a vibrating sound for about 80
seconds until drum refreshing is completed. The toner soiling on the ejected paper is normal
and does not indicate a fault.
Drum Refresh 2 (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) (page 10-30)
NOTE
Drum Refresh 2 cannot be performed while printing. Execute Drum Refresh 2 after the printing
is done.
Auto Drum Refresh This machine automatically performs Auto Drum Refresh to keep the best image quality by
monitoring its peripheral temperature and humidity. Auto Drum Refresh is performed when the
machine is powered on or recovered from Energy Saver mode.
Although you can select the time to perform Auto Drum Refresh, normally set it to [Normal]. If
[Off] or [Short] is selected, the best image quality may not be kept.
Value
Off: The Auto Drum Refresh will not be performed.
Short: Perform Auto Drum Refresh as Short.
Normal: Perform Auto Drum Refresh as Standard.
Long: Perform Auto Drum Refresh as Long.
Service Setting Settings for machine maintenance and inspection. This menu is primarily used by service
technicians to perform maintenance.
8-50
9 User Authentication and
Accounting (User Login,
Job Accounting)
This chapter explains the following topics:
Overview of User Login Administration .............................................................................................................. 9-2
Enabling User Login Administration ................................................................................................................... 9-3
Setting User Login Administration ...................................................................................................................... 9-4
Authentication Security ............................................................................................................................ 9-4
Adding a User (Local User List) ............................................................................................................... 9-6
Changing User Properties ....................................................................................................................... 9-9
User Login Administration for Printing ................................................................................................... 9-13
To Manage the Users to Scan Using TWAIN ........................................................................................ 9-15
To Manage the Users to Scan Using WIA ............................................................................................. 9-16
To Manage the Users that Send Faxes from a PC ................................................................................ 9-17
Local Authorization ................................................................................................................................ 9-18
Group Authorization Settings ................................................................................................................. 9-19
Guest Authorization Set. ........................................................................................................................ 9-22
Obtain NW User Property ...................................................................................................................... 9-25
Simple Login Settings ............................................................................................................................ 9-27
ID Card Settings .................................................................................................................................... 9-30
PIN Code Authorization ......................................................................................................................... 9-31
Using User Login Administration ...................................................................................................................... 9-32
Login/Logout .......................................................................................................................................... 9-32
Overview of Job Accounting ............................................................................................................................ 9-33
Enabling Job Accounting ................................................................................................................................. 9-34
Job Accounting Access .......................................................................................................................... 9-35
Setting an Account ........................................................................................................................................... 9-36
Adding an Account ................................................................................................................................. 9-36
Restricting the Use of the Machine ........................................................................................................ 9-37
Editing an Account ................................................................................................................................. 9-38
Deleting an Account ............................................................................................................................... 9-39
Job Accounting for Printing .................................................................................................................... 9-40
Job Accounting for Scan Using TWAIN ................................................................................................. 9-41
Job Accounting for Scan Using WIA ...................................................................................................... 9-42
Job Accounting for the FAX Transmitted from a Computer ................................................................... 9-43
Configuring Job Accounting ............................................................................................................................. 9-44
Default Setting ....................................................................................................................................... 9-44
Counting the Number of Pages Printed ................................................................................................. 9-45
Print Accounting Report ......................................................................................................................... 9-46
Using Job Accounting ...................................................................................................................................... 9-47
Login/Logout .......................................................................................................................................... 9-47
Unknown User Settings ................................................................................................................................... 9-48
Unknown ID Job .................................................................................................................................... 9-48
Registering Information for a User whose ID is Unknown ..................................................................... 9-49
9-1
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Overview of User Login Administration
1 Enable User Login 2 Set the user 3 Enter the login user name and
Administration (page 9-6) password and execute the job
(page 9-3) (page 9-32)
UserA
Access are in three levels - "User", "Administrator", and "Machine Administrator". The security levels can be modified
only by the "Machine Administrator".
User A
User B
User C
9-2
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Enabling User Login Administration
Item Descriptions
Local Authentication User authentication based on user properties on the local user list stored in the machine.
Network Authentication User authentication based on Authentication Server. Use a user property stored in
Authentication Server to access the network authentication login page.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
NOTE
• Selecting [Domain] displays the domain registration list.
• Enter the domain name. Up to 10 domain names can be registered.
2 "Do you want to add a new function to the home screen?" screen appears.To display a new
function on the Home screen, select [Yes] and specify the position in which you want to
display the icon of registered function.
NOTE
If the login user name and password are rejected, check the following settings.
• Network Authentication setting of the machine
• User property of the Authentication Server
• Date and time setting of the machine and the Authentication Server
If you cannot login because of the setting of the machine, login with any administrator
registered in the local user list and correct the settings.
9-3
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Authentication Security
If user authentication is enabled, configure the user authentication settings.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Authentication Security] > [User Account Lockout Settings]
Item Descriptions
Lockout Select whether or not account lockout policy is enabled.
Value: Off, On
Lockout Policy Specify the conditions and the extent to which the account lockout is
applied.
Value
Number of Retries until Locked:
Specify how many login retries are allowed until
the account is locked out.
(1 to 10 times)
Lockout Duration: Specify how long the account is to be locked out
until it is unlocked.
(1 to 60 minutes)
Lockout Target Specify the extent to which the account lockout
is applied. You can select from [All] or [Remote
Login Only]. Remote Login Only locks out all
operations from outside the operation panel.
Locked out Users List Displays a list of locked out users. You can unlock a user by selecting the
user in the list, and selecting [Unlock].
NOTE
This function is displayed when account lockout policy is enabled.
9-4
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Authentication Security] > [Password Policy Settings]
Item Descriptions
Minimum Password Set the minimum password length of characters for password.
Length Value: Off, On (1 to 64 characters)
Policy Violated User List of users do not meet password policy requirements.
List
9-5
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
By default, one of each default user with machine administrator rights and administrator privileges is already stored.
Each user's properties are:
Machine Administrator
User Name: DeviceAdmin
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Access Level: Machine Administrator
Administrator
User Name: Admin
Login User Name: Admin
Login Password: Admin
Access Level: Administrator
* Upper case and lower case letters are distinguished (case sensitive).
It is recommended to periodically change the user name, login user name and login password regularly for your
security.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-6
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Item Descriptions
User Name Enter the name displayed on the user list (up to 32 characters).
Login User Name Enter the login user name to login (up to 64 characters). The same login user
name cannot be registered.
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
Item Descriptions
User Name*1 Enter the name displayed on the user list (up to 32 characters).
Login User Enter the login user name to login (up to 64 characters). The same login user
Name*1 name cannot be registered.
Login Password Enter the password to login (up to 64 characters). Reenter the same password
for confirmation and select the [OK] key.
Account Name Add an account where the user belongs. The user, who registered his/her
account name, can login without entering the account ID.
Overview of Job Accounting (page 9-33)
NOTE
Select [Menu] > [Search (Name)] or [Search (ID)] to search by account name
or account ID.
Select [Menu] > [Sort (Name)] or [Sort (ID)] to sort the account list.
E-mail Address The user can register his/her E-mail address. The registered address will be
automatically selected for subsequent operations that need any E-mail function.
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional ID Card Authentication Kit is
activated.
Card Authentication Kit(B) "Card Authentication Kit" (page 11-3)
9-7
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Item Descriptions
My Panel You can register the language selection, initial screen, and shortcut settings for
each user. Settings registered here can be applied simply by logging in.
Local Set usage authority for each user.
Authorization*1 The following restriction items are available:
Printer:
Select whether or not use of the print function of the printer is prohibited.
Applicable print functions are as follows:
• Print from Box
• Print from Removable Memory
• Print Report
• Print from PC
Copy:
Select whether or not use of the copy print function is prohibited.
Duplex Restriction:
Select whether only duplex printing is allowed.
Combine Restrict.:
Specify whether only Combine is allowed.
EcoPrint Restriction:
Specify whether only EcoPrint is allowed.
Send:
Select whether or not use of the send function is prohibited.
FAX Transmission*2:
Select whether or not use of the fax send function is prohibited.
Storing in Box:
Select whether or not use of the box store function is prohibited.
Storing in Memory:
Select whether or not use of the removable memory store function is prohibited.
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
4 Select [Save].
A new user is added on the local user list.
NOTE
If simple login is enabled, a confirmation screen appears when new registration is finished
asking if you will configure simple login settings. To configure simple login settings, select
[Yes]. If you select [No], you will return to the user list screen.
For the procedure for configuring simple login settings, refer to the following:
Simple Login Settings (page 9-27)
9-8
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
To change the user information of the machine administrator, you must log in with machine administrator authority.
You can only view user information if you log in as a regular user.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Admin Admin
DeviceAdmin 5000
1/1
User A User A
Menu End
NOTE
• To sort the user list, select [Menu] > [Sort (User Name)] and [Sort (Login User
Name)].
• To search by name or login user name, select [Menu] > [Search (User Name)] or
[Search (Login User Name)].
9-9
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
2 Refer to step 3 of "Adding a User (Local User List)" to change a user property.
Deleting a user
2 [ ] > [Yes]
The selected user will be deleted.
NOTE
The default user with machine administrator rights cannot be deleted.
9-10
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Item Description
User Name Changes the name shown on the user list. Up to 32 characters can be
entered.
Login User Name Displays the login user name that is entered at login.
E-mail Address Changes the user's e-mail address. Up to 256 characters can be
entered.
If you log in as a user and [New Destination Entry] is set to
[Prohibit], you can only check the e-mail address.
Authorization Rules Displays the usage restriction that is set for the logged in user.
NOTE
[Job Accounting] shows the account name set for the logged in user
and the usage restrictions that are set for that account.
This function appears when job accounting is set to [On]. For
information on job accounting, refer to the following:
Job Accounting Access (page 9-35)
NOTE
This function is displayed when the optional ID Card Authentication
Kit is activated.
Card Authentication Kit(B) "Card Authentication Kit" (page 11-3)
This function does not appear when the server type is set to [Ext.] in
Network Authentication, and logged in with the user account
certificated in the server specified as the [Ext.] server type.
9-11
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Item Description
Simple Login When simple login is enabled, changes associated settings.
NOTE
This function does not appear when Simple Login is set to [Off] or the
user is not registered in Simple Login.
My Panel Register the language, default screen and shortcut for each user.
Once registered, the setting will be applied simply by login. Network
users are not displayed.
2 Select [Save].
The user information is changed.
9-12
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows, and then click [Devices and
Printers].
2 Right-click the printer driver icon of the machine, and click the [Printer properties] menu of
the printer driver.
9-13
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
3 Click [OK].
NOTE
For other settings of job accounting, refer to the following:
Printer Driver User Guide
9-14
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
In Windows 7, select [Start] button on the Windows, [All Programs], [Kyocera] and then
[TWAIN Driver Setting].
2 Select the checkbox beside [Authentication], and enter Login User Name and Password.
3 Click [OK].
9-15
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows and enter [Scanner] in [Program and
File Search]. Click [View scanners and cameras] in the search list then the Scanners
and Cameras screen appears.
2 Select the same name as this machine from WIA Drivers, and press [Properties].
1
2
1 2
2 Click [OK].
9-16
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows, and then click [Devices and
Printers].
2 Right-click the printer driver icon of the machine, and click the [Printer properties] menu of
the printer driver.
3 Click [OK].
9-17
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Local Authorization
Select whether or not to use Local Authorization.
NOTE
When using Local Authorization, the user authentication type must be set to [Local Authentication].
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-18
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
To use the group authorization settings, [Network Authentication] must be selected for the authentication method in
"Enabling User Login Administration". Select "On" for "LDAP" in "Protocol Settings".
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
Protocol Settings (page 8-31)
Group Authorization
Use the group authorization.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Group Authorization Set.] > [Group Authorization]
2 Select [On].
9-19
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Item Descriptions
Group ID*1 Enter the ID displayed on the group list (between 1 and 4294967295).
Group Name Enter the name displayed on the group list (up to 32 characters).
Printer Select whether or not to reject usage of print functions for the printer.
Applicable print functions are as follows:
• Print from Box
• Print from Removable Memory
• Print Report
• Print from PC
FAX Transmission*2 Select whether or not to reject usage of the FAX transmissions.
Storing in Box Select whether or not to reject usage of storing in the document boxes.
Storing in Memory Select whether or not to reject usage of storing in the removable memory.
*1 For "Group ID", specify PrimaryGroupID assigned by Active Directory of Windows. If you are using Windows Server 2008, check
Attribute Editor tab of user properties. If you are using Windows Server 2000/2003, check ADSIEdit. ADSIEdit is a support tool
included on the installation DVD for Windows Server OS (under \SUPPORT\TOOLS).
*2 Only on products with the fax function installed.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-20
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
2 [User Login Setting] > [Group Authorization] > [Group List] > [ ]
Others
1/1
Menu End
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
9-21
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
To use Guest Authorization Set., User Login Administration must be enabled in "Enabling User Login Administration".
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
Guest Authorization
Use the guest authorization.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Guest Authorization Set.] > [Guest Authorization]
2 Select [On].
NOTE
If the guest authorization setting is enabled, the [Authentication/Logout] key must be
selected when logging in.
In the guest user default settings, only monochrome copying can be used. If you wish to use
a different function, log in as a user who can use that function, or change the settings in the
guest properties.
9-22
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Guest Property
Register guest user information and functions that are restricted.
The table below explains the user information to be registered.
Item Descriptions
User Name Enter the name displayed on the user list (up to 32 characters).
The default setting is "Guest User".
Access Level The authority of the user appears. This cannot be changed.
9-23
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Guest Authorization Set.] > [Guest Property]
9-24
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
To obtain the network user property from the LDAP server, [Network Authentication] must be selected for the
authentication method in "Enabling User Login Administration". Select "On" for "LDAP" in "Protocol Settings".
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
Protocol Settings (page 8-31)
Item Descriptions
Server Name*1 Enter the LDAP server name or the IP address (up to 64 characters). If a server name is
not entered, user information will be acquired from the server set for Network
Authentication.
Port Set the LDAP port number or use the default port 389.
Name 1*2 Enter the LDAP Attribute to obtain the user name to be displayed from the LDAP server
(up to 32 characters).
Name 2*3 Enter the LDAP Attribute to obtain the user name to be displayed from the LDAP server
(up to 32 characters).
E-mail Address*4 Enter the LDAP Attribute to obtain the E-mail address from the LDAP server (up to 32
characters).
Authentic at Type*5 Set the authentication method. Select [Simple] or [SASL]. After changing the setting,
restart the system or turn the power off and then on.
Search Timeout Set the amount of time to wait before time-out in seconds (from 5 to 255 seconds).
*1 If using Active Directory of Windows, the server name may be the same as the server name entered in the network
authentication.
*2 If using Active Directory of Windows, displayName of Attribute may be used as "Name 1".
*3 "Name 2" can be left out. When you assign displayName in "Name 1" and department in "Name 2", and if the value of
displayName is "Mike Smith" and the value of department is "Sales" in Active Directory of Windows, the user name appears as
"Mike Smith Sales".
*4 If using Active Directory of Windows, mail of Attribute may be used as E-mail Address.
*5 Appears when the server type is set to "Kerberos" in "Network Authentication".
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-25
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
3 [Name 1] > Enter the LDAP Attribute to obtain the user name to be displayed > [OK]
5 If you set the server type to "Kerberos", select [Authentication Type] and set the
authentication method.
6 [E-mail Address] > Enter the LDAP Attribute to obtain the E-mail address > [OK]
7 Select [Search Timeout] to set the amount of time to wait before time-out.
8 Select [+], [-] or the numeric keys to enter the time > [OK] > [OK]
9-26
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
• For user registration, refer to the following:
Adding a User (Local User List) (page 9-6)
• To use Simple Login, User Login Administration must be enabled in "Enabling User Login Administration".
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
• When the guest authorization setting is enabled, the Simple Login screen is not displayed.
Simple Login
Select whether or not simple login is enabled.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Simple Login Settings] > [Simple Login]
9-27
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 [User Login Setting] > [Simple Login Settings] > [Simple Login Setup]
2 Select [ ].
Menu End
3 To specify the user from local users, select [Local User]. To specify from network users,
select [Network User].
The procedure differs depending on the transmission method selected.
NOTE
• To sort the user list, select [Menu] > [Sort (Name)] and [Sort (Login User Name)].
• To search by name or login user name, select [Menu] > [Search (Name)] or [Search
(Login User Name)].
9-28
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
Login Password
Keyboard
Select [Keyboard] for "Login User Name" and "Login Password", enter the information of the
user to be registered, and select [OK].
If you are specifying a user for whom a domain is set in network authentication, select the
"Domain" and select the domain where the user is registered.
Select [Next].
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
9-29
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
ID Card Settings
If ID card authentication is enabled, select the authentication type.
NOTE
This functions appears when the Card Authentication kit is activated.
Card Authentication Kit(B) "Card Authentication Kit" (page 11-3)
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Item Descriptions
Keyboard Login When ID card authentication is enabled, select whether or not login by
keyboard is allowed.
Value: Permit, Prohibit
*1 This function does not appear when the server type is set to [NTLM] or [Kerberos] in "Network
Authentication".
9-30
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting User Login Administration
NOTE
When using PIN Code Authorization, the network authentication must be enabled and [Ext.] must be selected for
server type.
Enabling User Login Administration (page 9-3)
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Select [OK].
9-31
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Using User Login Administration
Login/Logout
If user login administration is enabled, the login user name and login password entry screen appears each time you use
this machine.
Use the procedure below to login and logout.
Login
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, log in by referring to the following:
Login (page 2-22)
Logout
When the operations are complete, select the [Authentication/Logout] key to return to the login user name and login
password entry screen.
9-32
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Overview of Job Accounting
1 Enable job 2 Setting an 3 Enter the assigned account 4 Count the number of pages
accounting. (Refer account. (Refer ID when performing the copied, printed, scanned
to page 9-34.) to page 9-36.) job. (Refer to page 9-32.) and faxed.
A: 00000001
A: 00000001
C: 00000003
9-33
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Enabling Job Accounting
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Select [On].
NOTE
• To disable job accounting, select [Off].
• When the display returns to System Menu default screen, logout is automatically executed
and the screen to enter the Account ID appears. To continue the operation, enter the
Account ID.
9-34
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Enabling Job Accounting
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-35
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
Setting an Account
You can add, change and delete an account and set the restriction for each account.
Adding an Account
Up to 100 individual accounts can be added. The following entries are required.
Item Descriptions
Account Name Enter the account name (up to 32 characters).
Account ID Enter the account ID as many as eight digits (between 0 and 99999999).
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
NOTE
For details on entering characters, refer to the the following:
Character Entry Method (page 11-11)
NOTE
Any "Account ID" that has already registered cannot be used. Enter any other account ID.
4 Select [Save].
A new account is added on the Account List.
9-36
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
Restriction Items
"Individual" selected for Copy/Printer Count"Split" selected for Copy/Printer Count
Item Descriptions
Copy (Total) Limits the number of sheets used for copying.
FAX Transmission Limits the number of sheets sent by fax. This is displayed only on products with the
fax function installed.
Item Descriptions
Print (Total) Limits the total number of sheets used for copying and printing.
Print (Full Color) Limits the number of pages used for full-color printing.
FAX Transmission Limits the number of sheets sent by fax. This is displayed only on products with the
fax function installed.
Applying Restriction
Restriction can be applied in the following modes:
Item Descriptions
Off No restriction is applied.
Counter Limit Restricts the print counter in one-page increments up to 9,999,999 copies.
9-37
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
Editing an Account
This changes the registered account information.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Edit an account.
1 Select [ ] for the account name you wish to edit.
AAA 00000001
1/1
Menu End
NOTE
• To search by name or login user name, select [Menu] > [Search (Name)] or [Search
(ID)].
• To sort the user list, select [Menu] > [Sort (Name)] and [Sort (ID)].
2 Select the account information to be changed and change the account information.
9-38
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
Deleting an Account
This deletes the account.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
2 Delete an account.
1 Select the account name you wish to delete.
2 [ ] > [Yes]
The account is deleted.
9-39
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows, and then click [Devices and
Printers].
2 Right-click the printer driver icon of the machine, and click the [Printer properties] menu of
the printer driver.
9-40
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
3 Click [OK].
NOTE
For other settings of job accounting, refer to the following:
Printer Driver User Guide
NOTE
In Windows 7, select [Start] button on the Windows, [All Programs], [Kyocera] and then
[TWAIN Driver Setting].
2 Select the checkbox beside [Account], and enter the account ID.
3 Click [OK].
9-41
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows and enter [Scanner] in [Program and
File Search]. Click [View scanners and cameras] in the search list then the Scanners
and Cameras screen appears.
2 Select the same name as this machine from WIA Drivers, and press [Properties].
1
2
2 Click [OK].
9-42
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Setting an Account
NOTE
FAX functions are available only on products with the fax function installed.
NOTE
In Windows 7, click [Start] button on the Windows, and then click [Devices and
Printers].
2 Right click the name of the machine to be used as the FAX Driver and select [Printing
preferences] from the resulting pull-down menu.
3 Click [OK].
9-43
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Configuring Job Accounting
Item Description
Apply Limit This specifies how the machine behaves when the counter has reached the limit of restriction.
The table below describes the action taken.
Value
Immediately: Job stops when the counter reaches its limit. The next job will be
prohibited in sending or in storing in the box.
Subsequently: Printing/scanning of the job continues but the subsequent job will be
rejected.
Alert Only: Job continues while displaying an alert message.
Copy/Print Count You can select how the copying and printing page counts are shown - either the total of both or
each of copying and printing individually (Split). The selection may influence restriction on the
count and count method.
Value: Total, Individual
Restricting the Use of the Machine (page 9-37)
Print Accounting Report (page 9-46)
Counter Limit When you add a new account, you can change the default restrictions on the number of sheets
used. You can set any number from 1 to 9,999,999.
The items that can be set differ depending on whether [Individual] or [Total] is selected for
[Copy/Print Count].
Copy/Print Count (page 9-44)
Copy (Total) Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for copying.
Printer (Total) Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for printing.
Applicable print functions are as follows:
• Print from Box
• Print from Removable Memory
• Print Report
• Print from PC
Scan (Others) Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for scanning (excludes copying).
FAX Transmission*1 Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for sending faxes.
Print (Total) Sets the default restriction on the total number of sheets used for copying and printing.
Scan (Others) Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for scanning (excludes copying).
FAX Transmission*1 Sets the default restriction on the number of sheets used for sending faxes.
9-44
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Configuring Job Accounting
Total Accounting
This counts the number of pages for all accounts and resets the counts for those accounts together at the same time.
Item Descriptions
Printed Pages Displays the number of pages copied and printed, and the total number of pages used. You can
also use [FAX]*1, [by Duplex] and [by Combine] to check the number of pages used.
Copy/Print. (Total) Displays the total number of pages used for copying and printing.
by Duplex Displays the number of pages printed in [1-sided] mode, [2-sided] mode, and the total pages
in both modes.
by Combine Displays the number of pages printed in [None] (no Combine) mode, [2 in 1] mode, [4 in 1]
mode, and the total pages in both modes.
Scanned Pages Displays the number of pages scanned for copying, faxing and other functions, as well as the
total number of pages scanned.
9-45
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Configuring Job Accounting
ACCOUNT. REPORT
1 Prepare paper.
Check that A4 or Letter paper is loaded in the cassette.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name and
password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-46
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Using Job Accounting
Login/Logout
If job accounting is enabled, an account ID entry screen appears each time you use this machine.
Use the procedure below to login and logout.
Login
1 In the account ID entry screen, enter the account ID using the numeric keys and select
[Login].
NOTE
• If you entered a wrong character, select the [Clear] key and enter the account ID
again.
• If the entered account ID does not match the registered ID, a warning beep will sound
and login will fail. Enter the correct account ID.
• By selecting [Check Counter], you can refer to the number of pages printed and the
number of pages scanned.
When the screen to enter the login user name and password appears
If user login administration is enabled, the screen to enter the login user name and password
appears. Enter a login user name and password to login. If the user has already registered the
account information, the account ID entry would be skipped.
Adding a User (Local User List) (page 9-6)
Logout
When the operations are complete, select the [Authentication/Logout] key to return to the account ID entry screen.
9-47
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Unknown User Settings
Item Descriptions
Permit The job is permitted to be printed.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
9-48
User Authentication and Accounting (User Login, Job Accounting) > Unknown User Settings
NOTE
This function is displayed when [Unknown ID Job] is set to [Permit].
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Item Descriptions
User Name Enter the name displayed on the user list (up to 32 characters).
NOTE
• Select [Menu] > [Search (Name)] or [Search (ID)] to search by
account name or account ID.
• Select [Menu] > [Sort (Name)] or [Sort (ID)] to sort the account list.
• This is displayed when job accounting is enabled.
9-49
10 Troubleshooting
This chapter explains the following topics:
Regular Maintenance ....................................................................................................................................... 10-2
Cleaning ................................................................................................................................................. 10-2
Toner Container Replacement ............................................................................................................... 10-6
Waste Toner Box Replacement ........................................................................................................... 10-10
Replacing Staples (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) ................................................... 10-12
Troubleshooting ............................................................................................................................................. 10-13
Solving Malfunctions ............................................................................................................................ 10-13
Responding to Messages .................................................................................................................... 10-18
Adjustment/Maintenance ..................................................................................................................... 10-30
Clearing Paper Jams ........................................................................................................................... 10-31
Clearing a Staple Jam (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) .............................................. 10-40
10-1
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
Regular Maintenance
Cleaning
Clean the machine regularly to ensure optimum printing quality.
CAUTION
For safety, always unplug the power cord before cleaning the machine.
Glass Platen
Wipe the inside of the document processor and the glass platen with a soft cloth dampened with alcohol or mild
detergent.
IMPORTANT
Do not use thinner or other organic solvents.
10-2
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
Slit Glass
When using the document processor, clean the slit glass surface and the reading guide with the dry cloth.
IMPORTANT
Do not use water, soap or solvents for cleaning.
NOTE
Dirt on the slit glass or the reading guide may cause black streaks to appear in the output.
10-3
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
Registration Roller
Transfer roller
(Black)
IMPORTANT
Be careful not to touch the black transfer roller and brown transfer belt during
cleaning as this may adversely affect print quality.
10-4
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
Vents
Use a lint free cloth to clean dust and dirt away from the vents.
10-5
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
NOTE
• The average number of pages that can be printed by the toner containers included with the machine are as follows.
ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: 6,000 images. ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: 10,000 images.
• To maintain quality, we recommend using genuine Kyocera toner containers, which must pass numerous quality
inspections.
• The memory chip in the toner container of this product stores information necessary for improving customer
convenience, operation of the recycling system for used toner containers, and planning and development of new
products. The stored information does not include information that makes it possible to identify individuals, and is
only used anonymously for the above purposes.
CAUTION
Do not attempt to incinerate parts which contain toner. Dangerous sparks may cause burns.
10-6
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
NOTE
When removing the toner container from the machine, lift up the right hand side first.
10-7
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
IMPORTANT
Do not touch the points shown below.
10-8
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
NOTE
• If the front cover does not close, check that the new toner container is installed correctly (in step 7).
• Return the exhausted toner container to your dealer or service representative. The collected toner container will be
recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
10-9
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
CAUTION
Do not attempt to incinerate parts which contain toner. Dangerous sparks may cause burns.
10-10
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
NOTE
Return the exhausted waste toner box to your dealer or service representative. The collected waste toner box will be
recycled or disposed in accordance with the relevant regulations.
10-11
Troubleshooting > Regular Maintenance
Replacing Staples
(ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only)
Add staples to the optional manual stapler.
NOTE
If the Staple Unit runs out of staples, contact your dealer or service representative.
10-12
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
Solving Malfunctions
The table below provides general guidelines for problem solving.
If a problem occurs with your machine, look into the checkpoints and perform procedures indicated on the following
pages. If the problem persists, contact your Service Representative.
NOTE
When contacting us, the serial number will be necessary.
To check the serial number, refer to the following:
Display for Device Information (page 2-17)
Checking the Equipment's Serial Number (page i)
Reference
Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
An application does not Is the Auto Panel Reset time short? Set the Auto Panel Reset time to 30 page 8-46
start. seconds or more.
The screen does not Check the power cord. Connect both ends of the power cord page 2-9
respond when the main securely.
power switch is turned on.
Pressing the [Start] key Is there a message on the screen? Determine the appropriate response to page 10-18
does not produce copies. the message and respond accordingly.
Is the machine in Sleep mode? Select any key on the operation panel to page 2-33
recover the machine from Sleep mode.
Blank sheets are ejected. Are the originals loaded correctly? When placing originals on the platen, page 5-2
place them face-down and align them
with the original size indicator plates.
Printouts are totally too light. Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. page 3-2
Have you changed the density? Select appropriate density level. page 6-13
page 8-49
Is the toner distributed evenly within the Shake the toner container from side to page 10-6
toner container? side several times.
10-13
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Printouts are too dark even Have you changed the density? Select appropriate density level. page 6-13
though the background of page 8-49
the scanned original is white.
Copies have a moire pattern Is the original a printed photograph? Set the original image to [Photo]. page 6-14
(dots grouped together in
patterns and not aligned
uniformly).
Texts are not clearly printed. Did you choose appropriate image Select appropriate image quality. page 6-14
quality for the original?
Black dots appear on the Is the original holder or the glass platen Clean the original holder or the glass page 10-2
white background when dirty? platen.
white original is scanned.
Printouts are fuzzy. Is the machine being used in conditions Use in an environment that has suitable ―
of very humid, or humidity or humidity.
temperature rapidly changes?
Images are skewed. Are the originals placed correctly? When placing originals on the platen, align page 5-2
them with the original size indicator plates.
Is the paper loaded correctly? Check the position of the paper width page 3-4
guides. page 3-11
10-14
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
The altitude is 1000 m or ― Select the [System Menu/Counter] key ―
higher and irregular > [Adjustment/Maintenance] >
horizontal white lines appear [Service Setting] > [Altitude
in the image. Adjustment], and set to an elevation
one level higher than the current setting.
Paper often jams. Is the paper loaded correctly? Load the paper correctly. page 3-2
Is the paper of the supported type? Is it Remove the paper, turn it over, and page 3-4
in good condition? reload it.
Is the paper curled, folded or wrinkled? Replace the paper with new paper. page 3-4
Are there any loose scraps or jammed Remove any jammed paper. page 10-31
paper in the machine?
Printouts are wrinkled. Is the paper loaded correctly? Load the paper correctly. page 3-2
Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. page 3-2
Printouts are curled. Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. page 3-2
Cannot print. Is the machine plugged in? Plug the power cord into an AC outlet. ―
Is the machine powered on? Turn on the power switch. page 2-10
Are the USB cable and network cable Connect the correct USB cable and page 2-8
connected? network cable securely.
10-15
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Cannot print with USB Is the USB host blocked? Select [Unblock] in the USB host page 8-41
memory. settings.
USB memory not
― Check that the USB memory is securely ―
recognized.
plugged into the machine.
Printouts have vertical lines. Is the slit glass dirty? Clean the slit glass. page 10-3
Dirt on the top edge or back Is the interior of the machine dirty? Clean the interior of the machine. page 10-4
of the paper.
Print on the back of the ― Set [Prevent Bleed-through] to [On]. page 6-17
sheet is visible on the front. page 8-15
[Multi originals fed at Is the sensor dirty with paper dust, etc.? Open the document processor cover ―
once.] is often displayed and clean two sensors shown in the
though no multi originals are figure below with dry cloth.
not fed.
Lines appear on ruled lines. Is the paper damp? Replace the paper with new paper. page 3-2
10-16
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Symptom Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Part of the image has come ― Select the [System Menu/Counter] key ―
off (poor toner fixation). > [Adjustment/Maintenance] >
[Service Setting] >
[Fuser Adjustment], and set to [2].
Cannot send via SMB. Is the network cable connected? Connect the correct network cable page 2-8
securely.
Have the network settings for the Configure the TCP/IP settings properly. page 8-29
equipment been configured properly?
Have the folder sharing settings been Check sharing settings and access page 3-20
configured properly? privileges under the folder properties.
Has the SMB protocol been set to [On]? Set the SMB protocol setting to [On]. page 8-32
Has [Host Name] been entered Check the name of the computer to page 5-23
properly? *1 which data is being sent.
Has [Path] been entered properly? Check the share name for the shared page 5-23
folder.
Has [Login User Name] been entered Check the domain name and login user page 5-23
properly? *1 *2 name.
Has the same domain name been used for Delete the domain name and backslash page 5-23
[Host Name] and [Login User Name]? ("/") from [Login User Name].
Has [Login Password] been entered Check the login password. page 5-23
properly?
Have exceptions for Windows Firewall Configure exceptions for Windows page 3-24
been configured properly? Firewall properly.
Do the time settings for the equipment, Set the equipment, domain server, and ―
domain server, and data destination data destination computer to the same
computer differ? time.
Is the screen displaying Send error? Refer to Responding to Send Error. page 10-27
Cannot send via the e-mail. Is the E-mail send size limit set in the Check the limit value is entered to "E- page 2-59
SMTP server registered on the mail Size Limit" of [E-mail] setting in
machine? Command Center RX and change the
value as necessary.
The machine is emitting Check the room temperature to see if it Depending on the printing environment ―
steam in the area around the is low, or if damp paper was used. and the paper's condition, the heat
paper ejection slot. generated during printing will cause the
moisture in the paper to evaporate, and
the steam emitted may look like smoke.
This is not a problem, and you can
continue printing. If the steam concerns
you, raise the room temperature, or
replace the paper with a newer, dryer
paper.
*1 You can also enter a full computer name as the host name (for example, pc001.abcdnet.com).
*2 You can also enter login user names in the following formats:
Domain_name/user_name (for example, abcdnet/james.smith)
User_name@domain_name (for example, james.smith@abcdnet)
10-17
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Responding to Messages
If the touch panel or the computer displays any of these messages, follow the corresponding procedure.
NOTE
When contacting us, the serial number will be necessary. To check the serial number, refer to the following:
Display for Device Information (page 2-17)
Checking the Equipment's Serial Number (page i)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Activation error. ― Turn the main power switch off and page 2-10
on. If the error exists, contact
administrator.
Add the following paper Does the selected paper size Select [Continue] to continue —
in cassette #. matches the paper size loaded in printing.
the specified paper source? Select [Cancel] to cancel the job.
Add the following paper Does the selected paper size Select [Continue] to continue —
in the multi purpose tray. matches the paper size loaded in printing.
the specified paper source? Select [Cancel] to cancel the job.
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Box is not found. ― The specified box cannot be found. —
Job is canceled. Select [End].
Box limit exceeded.*1 Is [End] displayed on the screen? The specified box is full, and no —
further storage is available; Job is
canceled. Select [End]. Try to
perform the job again after printing
or deleting data from the box.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
10-18
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Cannot connect to — Set machine time to match the page 2-24
Authentication Server.*1 server's time.
Cannot duplex print on Did you select a paper size/type Select [Paper Selection] to select page 6-22
the following paper.*1 that cannot be duplex printed? the available paper. Select
[Continue] to print without using
Duplex function.
NOTE
If you unchecked the [RAM Disk],
check the [RAM Disk] again after
the printing is completed. If not,
print speed may be reduced.
Check the toner — The toner container is not installed page 10-6
container. correctly. Set it correctly.
Check waste toner box. — The waste toner box is not installed page 10-10
correctly. Set it correctly.
Is the waste toner box full? Replace the waste toner box.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
10-19
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Error occurred at ― Remove the indicated cassette. ―
cassette #. Select [Next >] to follow the
instructions.
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Failed to specify Job — Failed to specify Job Accounting —
Accounting.*1 when processing the job externally.
The job is canceled. Select [End].
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Incorrect account ID.*1 — The account ID was incorrect when —
processing the job externally. The
job is canceled. Select [End].
Inner tray is full of paper. — Remove paper from the inner tray. —
Select [Continue] to resume
printing. Select [Cancel] to cancel
the job.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
10-20
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Job Accounting Is the acceptable printing count The printing count exceeded the ―
restriction exceeded. restricted by Job Accounting acceptable count restricted by Job
exceeded? Accounting. Cannot print any more.
This job is canceled. Select [End].
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
KPDL error.*1 ― PostScript error has occurred. The ―
job is canceled. Select [End].
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Machine failure. ― Internal error has occurred. Make a ―
note of the error code displayed on
the screen, and contact your
Service Representative.
Maximum number of Is the acceptable scanning count Only one copy of the scanned pages —
scanned pages. exceeded? is available. Select [Continue] to
print, send or store the scanned
pages. Select [Cancel] to cancel
printing, sending or storing.
Memory card error. ― An error has occurred on the —
memory card. Job is canceled.
Select [End].
04: Insufficient space on the
memory card to complete this
operation. Move data or delete
unneeded data.
10-21
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Memory is full.*1 — The process cannot be performed —
due to insufficient memory. The job
is canceled. Select [End].
The machine may reproduce the
same originals by arranging the
following setting:
• Decrease [Image Quality] of
[File Format].
— Unable to continue the job as the —
memory is used up. Select
[Continue] to print the scanned
pages. The print job cannot be
processed completely. Select
[Cancel] to cancel the job.
The machine may reproduce the
same originals by arranging the
following settings:
• Select [On] of RAM Disk Setting
in System Menu, and then
decrease the RAM disk size.
• Select [Printer Priority] of
Optional Memory in System Menu.
NOTE
Before changing the RAM Disk
Setting or Optional Memory setting,
contact your administrator.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Non-genuine Toner. Is the installed toner container our We will not be liable for any damage —
own brand? caused by the use of third party
supplies in this machine.
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Paper jam. ― If a paper jam occurs, the machine page 10-31
will stop and the location of the jam
will be indicated on the screen.
Leave the machine on and follow
the instruction to remove the
jammed paper.
10-22
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
RAM disk error. ― An error has occurred on the RAM page 8-42
disk. Job is canceled. Select [End].
The possible error codes and their
descriptions are as follows.
04: Insufficient space on the RAM
disk. If the optional RAM dis is
installed, increase the RAM disk
size by changing RAM Disk Setting
in System Menu.
NOTE
The range of RAM disk size can be
increased by selecting [Printer
Priority] in Optional Memory.
Remove originals in the Are there any originals left in the Remove originals from the ―
document processor. document processor? document processor.
10-23
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Replace MK. — Replacement of the parts in the —
maintenance kit is necessary at
every 300,000 pages (ECOSYS
M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn) or
500,000 pages (ECOSYS
M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn) of
printing and requires professional
servicing. Contact your Service
Representative.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Scanner memory is — Scanning cannot be performed due —
full.*1 to insufficient memory of scanner.
Only one copy of the scanned
pages is available. Select
[Continue] to print, send or store
the scanned pages. Select [Cancel]
to cancel the printing job.
The machine may reproduce the
same originals by arranging the
following settings:
• Reduce the number of originals
to be scanned at once.
Furthermore, the machine may
reproduce the same originals by
arranging the following settings:
• Select [Copy Priority] of
Optional Memory in System
Menu.
NOTE
Before changing the Optional
Memory setting, contact your
administrator.
Shake the toner — Shake the toner container well and page 10-6
container. reinstall it.
10-24
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
SSD error. — An error has occurred on SSD. Job —
is canceled. Select [End].
The possible error codes and their
descriptions are as follows.
01: The amount of data that can be
saved at once has been exceeded.
Turn the power OFF/ON. If the error
still occurs, divide the file into
smaller files. If the error occurs after
the file is divided, the specified file
may be damaged. Delete the file.
04: Insufficient space on SSD to
complete this operation. Move data
or delete unneeded data.
*1 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
*2 When Auto Error Clear is set to [On], processing resumes automatically after a set amount of time elapses. For details
on Auto Error Clear, refer to the following:
Auto Error Clear (page 8-48)
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
The cover is open. Is the top cover of the document Close the document processor ―
processor open? cover.
Is there any cover which is open? Close the cover indicated on the
screen.
The manufacturer Is the installed toner container our We will not be liable for any damage ―
assumes no own brand? caused by the use of third party
responsibility for supplies in this machine. If you want
damage caused by a to continue, select [Next].
non-genuine toner.
The password does not Is the password expired? Change the login password. page 9-5
meet password policy. Job is canceled. Select Press
[End].
Is the password policy requirement Confirm the password policy page 9-5
(such as password length or requirements and change the login
required characters) changed? password.
Job is canceled. Select Press
[End].
The slit glass requires — Clean the slit glass. page 10-3
cleaning.
This memory is not Is the removable memory formatted Perform [Format] on this machine. page 7-11
formatted. by this machine?
10-25
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Toner is empty. — Replace the toner container to our page 10-6
specified toner container.
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Unknown Toner Does the installed toner container's Install the specified container. —
Installed. PC [K] regional specification match the
machine's?
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
Warning low memory. — Cannot start the job. Try again later. —
Reference
Message Checkpoints Corrective Actions
Page
You cannot use this box. — You cannot use the specified box. —
Job is canceled. Job is canceled. Select [End].
10-26
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Error Reference
Message Corrective Actions
Code Page
1101 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the host name of the SMTP server on the page 2-59
Command Center RX.
Failed to send via FTP. Check the host name of FTP. page 5-23
Failed to send via SMB. Check the host name of SMB. page 5-23
1102 Failed to send via SMB. Check the SMB settings. page 5-23
• Login user name and login password
NOTE
If the sender is a domain user, specify the domain
name.
• Host name
• Path
Failed to send the e-mail. Check the following on the Command Center RX. page 2-59
• SMTP login user name and login password
• POP3 login user name and login password
• E-mail size limit
Failed to send via FTP. Check the FTP settings. page 5-23
• Login user name and login password
NOTE
If the sender is a domain user, specify the domain
name.
• Path
• Folder share permissions of the recipient
1103 Failed to send via SMB. Check the SMB settings. page 5-23
• Login user name and login password
NOTE
If the sender is a domain user, specify the domain
name.
• Path
• Folder share permissions of the recipient
Failed to send via FTP. Check the FTP settings. page 5-23
• Path
• Folder share permissions of the recipient
1104 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the e-mail address. page 5-22
NOTE
If the address is rejected by the domain, you cannot
send the email.
10-27
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Error Reference
Message Corrective Actions
Code Page
1105 Failed to send via SMB. Check the following settings. page 8-32
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] >
[Network] > [Protocol Settings] >
[SMB Client (Transmission)]
Failed to send the e-mail. Select [On] of the SMTP settings on the Command page 2-59
Center RX.
Failed to send via FTP. Check the following settings. page 8-32
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] >
[Network] > [Protocol Settings] >
[FTP Client (Transmission)]
1106 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the sender address of SMTP on the Command page 2-59
Center RX.
1131 Failed to send via FTP. Enable the SSL. page 8-37
[System Menu/Counter] key > [System/Network] >
[Network] > [Security Settings] > [SSL]
1132 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the following of the SMTP server. Refer to the
• Is SMTP over SSL available? Command
Center RX
• Is the encryption available? User Guide.
Failed to send via FTP. Check the following of the FTP server. —
• Is FTPS available?
• Is the encryption available?
2101 Failed to send via SMB. Check the network and SMB settings. —
• The network cable is connected.
• The hub is not operating properly.
• The server is not operating properly.
• Host name and IP address
• Port number
Failed to send via FTP. Check the network and FTP settings. —
• The network cable is connected.
• The hub is not operating properly.
• The server is not operating properly.
• Host name and IP address
• Port number
Failed to send the e-mail. Check the network and Command Center RX. page 2-59
• The network cable is connected.
• The hub is not operating properly.
• The server is not operating properly.
• POP3 server name of the POP3 user
• SMTP server name
10-28
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Error Reference
Message Corrective Actions
Code Page
2102 Failed to send via FTP. Check the network. —
2103 • The network cable is connected.
• The hub is not operating properly.
• The server is not operating properly.
2204 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the e-mail size limit of the SMTP settings on page 2-59
the Command Center RX.
3101 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the authentication methods of both the sender —
and the recipient.
3201 Failed to send the e-mail. Check the SMTP user authentication method of the —
recipient.
0007 — Turn the main power switch off and back on. If this page 2-10
4201 error occurs several times, make a note of the
displayed error code and contact your service
4701
representative.
5101
5102
5103
5104
7101
7102
7103
720f
10-29
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Adjustment/Maintenance
Drum Refresh/Drum Refresh 1
Remove image blur from the printout.
NOTE
Drum Refresh 1 cannot be performed while printing. Execute Drum Refresh 1 after the printing is done.
NOTE
Drum Refresh 2 cannot be performed while printing. Execute Drum Refresh 2 after the printing is done.
1 Load paper.
Load A4 or Letter size paper into the Multipurpose tray.
NOTE
When you run [Drum Refresh 2], the machine sometimes makes a vibrating sound for about
80 seconds until drum refreshing is completed. The toner soiling on the ejected paper is
normal and does not indicate a fault.
10-30
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
If a paper jam occurs, the location of the jam will be displayed on the touch panel as well as the clearing instructions.
10:10
F
Paper jam.
A
JAM 0501 1/2 D
< Back Next > E
B
C
B
After you remove the jam, the machine will warm up again and the error message will be cleared. The machine resumes
with the page that was printing when the jam occurred.
10-31
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
CAUTION
The fixing unit is extremely hot. Take sufficient care when working in this area, as there is a danger of getting
burned.
10-32
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Cassettes 1 to 5
Procedures for handling a paper jam in Cassettes 1 to 5 are all the same. This section explains procedures using
Cassette 1 as an example.
10-33
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Duplex Unit
10-34
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
If the jammed paper appears to be pinched by rollers, pull it along the normal running direction
of the paper.
If you cannot find a paper jam, try checking inside the rear of the printer.
Inner Tray / Inside Rear Cover (page 10-36)
10-35
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
If you cannot find a paper jam, try checking inside the rear of the machine.
CAUTION
The fixing unit is extremely hot. Take sufficient care when working in this area, as
there is a danger of getting burned.
10-36
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
Document Processor
10-37
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
10-38
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
10-39
Troubleshooting > Troubleshooting
10-40
11 Appendix
This chapter explains the following topics:
Optional Equipment ......................................................................................................................................... 11-2
Overview of Optional Equipment ........................................................................................................... 11-2
Optional Applications ............................................................................................................................. 11-9
Character Entry Method ................................................................................................................................. 11-11
Entry Screens ...................................................................................................................................... 11-11
Entering Characters ............................................................................................................................. 11-13
Paper ............................................................................................................................................................. 11-14
Basic Paper Specifications .................................................................................................................. 11-14
Choosing the Appropriate Paper ......................................................................................................... 11-15
Special Paper ...................................................................................................................................... 11-18
Specifications ................................................................................................................................................. 11-22
Machine ............................................................................................................................................... 11-22
Copy Functions .................................................................................................................................... 11-24
Printer Functions .................................................................................................................................. 11-25
Scanner Functions ............................................................................................................................... 11-26
Document Processor ........................................................................................................................... 11-27
Paper Feeder (500-sheet) (Option) ..................................................................................................... 11-27
Manual Stapler (ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only) ........................................................ 11-28
Glossary ......................................................................................................................................................... 11-29
11-1
Appendix > Optional Equipment
Optional Equipment
Overview of Optional Equipment
The following optional equipment is available for the machine.
(10) IB-36
(9) MS-5100B*
(2) PF-3110
(8) PT-320*
(3) Expansion Memory
Software option
(11) Data Security Kit(E)
(12) UG-33
(5) HD-6/HD-7 (6) IB-50 (7) IB-51
(13) Scan extension kit(A)
11-2
Appendix > Optional Equipment
11-3
Appendix > Optional Equipment
To protect electronic parts, discharge static electricity from your body by touching a water pipe (faucet) or other large
metal object before handling the memory modules. Or, wear an antistatic wrist strap, if possible, when you install the
memory modules.
1 Turn off the machine and disconnect the power cord and interface cable.
NOTE
If the optional IB-50/51 or HD-6/7 is installed, remove it.
4 With the memory connection terminal pointing toward the socket, align the cut-out part with
the socket terminal and insert directly in at an angle.
5 Carefully press the inserted memory down and into the machine.
11-4
Appendix > Optional Equipment
11-5
Appendix > Optional Equipment
3 Insert the SD/SDHC memory card into the SD/SDHC memory card slot.
5 Insert the power cord into the socket and turn on the power switch.
11-6
Appendix > Optional Equipment
11-7
Appendix > Optional Equipment
11-8
Appendix > Optional Equipment
Optional Applications
Overview of the Applications
The applications listed below are installed on this machine.
Application
Data Security Kit
ThinPrint Option*1
NOTE
• Restrictions such as the number of times the application can be used during the trial period differ depending on the
application.
• If you change the date/time while using the trial version of an application, you will no longer be able to use the
application.
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
NOTE
• If you started the Security Kit or Thin Print option and entered the license key, turn the
power OFF/ON.
• Icons of activated application are displayed in the Home screen.
11-9
Appendix > Optional Equipment
NOTE
If the login user name entry screen appears during operations, enter a login user name
and password, and select [Login]. For this, you need to login with administrator
privileges.
The factory default login user name and login password are set as shown below.
ECOSYS M3145idn ECOSYS M3655idn ECOSYS M3660idn
ECOSYS M3645idn
Login User Name: 4500 5500 6000
Login Password: 4500 5500 6000
Item
Function Name
License
Remaining Counts
Expiration Date
Status
11-10
Appendix > Character Entry Method
NOTE
Keyboard Layout
"QWERTY", "QWERTZ" and "AZERTY" are available as keyboard layouts the same as a PC keyboard. Select the
[System Menu/Counter] key, [Common Settings] and then [Keyboard Layout] to choose the desired layout.
"QWERTY" layout is used here as an example. You may use another layout following the same steps.
Entry Screens
Lower-case Letter Entry Screen
12 11 10 9 8
Add - Name
1 Abc Input: 3
Limit: 32
ABC A/a Del.
q w e r t y u i o p
2 a s d f g h j k l 7
@ z x c v b n m . 6
Cancel < Back Next >
3 4 5
No. Display/Key Description
1 Display Displays entered characters.
3 [Cancel] Select to cancel entered characters and return to the screen before
the entry was made.
5 [OK] / [Next >] Select to save the entered characters and move to the next screen.
11 [A/a] / [a/A] Select to switch between upper case and lower case.
12 [ABC] / [Symbol] Select the characters that are entered. To enter symbols or numbers,
select [Symbol].
11-11
Appendix > Character Entry Method
Add - Name
AB Input: 2
Limit: 32
ABC A/a Del.
Q W E R T Y U I O P
A S D F G H J K L
_ Z X C V B N M ~
Cancel < Back Next >
Add - Name
123 Input: 3
Limit: 32
Symbol ņ Del.
13
11-12
Appendix > Character Entry Method
Entering Characters
Follow the steps below to enter 'List A-1' for an example.
4
ABC A/a Del. ABC A/a Del.
Q W E R T Y U
2
I O P q w e r t y u i o 7p
5 6
A S D F G H J K L a s d f g h j k l
_ Z X C V B N M ~ @ z x c v b n m .
Cancel < Back Next > Cancel < Back Next >
To shift from lower case to upper case letters, select [a/A]. To shift from upper case to lower
case letters, select [A/a].
2 Enter 'A-1'.
Add - Name Add - Name
List A 2 Input: 6
Limit: 32
List A-1 Input:
Limit:
8
32
ABC A/a Del.
4 Symbol ņ Del.
1 Q W E R T Y U I O P
A S D F G H J K L
_ Z X C V B N M ~ 3
Cancel < Back Next > Cancel < Back Next >
11-13
Appendix > Paper
Paper
This section explains the paper sizes and types that can be used in the paper source.
For details on the sizes, types, and number of sheets of paper that can be loaded in each paper tray, refer to the
following:
Specifications (page 11-22)
Supported Paper
Use standard copy paper for regular copiers or laser printers. The printing quality will be affected by the quality of paper.
Poor quality paper may result in unsatisfactory output.
Criteria Specifications
Weight Cassettes: 60 to 120 g/m2
Moisture content 4 to 6%
NOTE
Some recycled paper does not meet requirements for use with this machine as listed in the Basic Paper Specifications
shown below, such as moisture or pulp content. For this reason, we recommend purchasing a small amount of
recycled paper as a sample for testing prior to use. Choose recycled paper that gives the best printing results and
contains low levels of paper dust.
We are not responsible for the problems occurred from the use of paper that does not conform to our specifications.
11-14
Appendix > Paper
Condition
Avoid using paper with bent corners or that is curled, dirty, or torn. Do not use paper that has a rough surface or paper
fiber lint, or that is especially delicate. Use of paper in any of these conditions will not only deliver poor copies but may
also cause jams and shorten the useful life of the machine. Choose paper with a smooth and even surface; however,
avoid coated paper or paper with a treated surface as it may damage the drum or fusing unit.
Ingredients
Do not use paper such as paper that has been coated or surface-treated or paper that contains plastic or carbon. Those
types of paper may produce harmful fumes from the heat of printing and may damage the drum.
Be sure to use the standard paper that contains at least 80% pulp, i.e., not more than 20% of the total paper content
consists of cotton or other fibers.
Letter
Legal
Oficio II
216 × 340 mm
11-15
Appendix > Paper
Custom Cassette 1:
ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn
140 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm
ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn
105 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm
Cassettes 2 to 5: 92 × 162 to 216 × 356 mm
Multi Purpose Tray: 70 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm
Smoothness
The paper surface should be smooth, but it must be uncoated. With paper that is too smooth and slippery, several
sheets may accidentally be supplied at once, causing jams.
Basis Weight
In countries that use the metric system, basis weight is the weight in grams of one sheet of paper one square meter in
area. In the United States, basis weight is the weight in pounds of one ream (500 sheets) of paper cut to the standard
size (or trade size) for a specific grade of paper. Paper that is too heavy or too light may be supplied incorrectly or cause
paper jams, which may cause excessive wear of the machine. Mixed paper weight (i.e., thickness) may cause several
sheets to be supplied at once accidentally and may also cause blurring or other printing problems if the toner fails to
adhere correctly.
Moisture Content
Paper moisture content is the ratio of moisture to dryness expressed as a percentage. Moisture affects how the paper is
supplied, the electrostatic chargeability of the paper, and how the toner adheres.
Paper moisture content varies depending on the relative humidity in the room. High relative humidity causes paper to
become damp, making the edges expand so it appears wavy. Low relative humidity causes paper to lose moisture,
making the edges tighten and weakening print contrast.
Wavy or tight edges may cause the paper to slip when it is supplied. Try to keep the moisture content between 4 to 6%.
To maintain the right level of moisture content, bear in mind the following considerations.
• Store paper in a cool, well-ventilated place.
• Store paper flat and unopened in the package. Once the package is opened, reseal it if the paper is not to be used for
a while.
• Store paper sealed in the original package and box. Put a pallet under the carton to keep it raised above the floor.
Especially during rainy seasons keep the paper a sufficient distance away from wooden or concrete floors.
• Before using paper that has been stored, keep it at the proper moisture level for at least 48 hours.
• Do not store paper where it is exposed to heat, sunlight, or dampness.
11-16
Appendix > Paper
11-17
Appendix > Paper
Special Paper
This section describes printing onto special paper and print media.
The following paper and media can be used.
• Transparencies
• Preprinted paper
• Bond paper
• Recycled paper
• Thin paper
• Letterhead
• Colored paper
• Prepunched paper
• Envelopes
• Hagaki (Cardstock)
• Thick paper
• Labels
• High-quality paper
When using these paper and media, choose those that are designed specifically for copiers or page printers (such as
laser printers). Use the multi purpose tray for transparencies, thick paper, envelopes, cardstocks, and label paper.
Transparencies
Transparencies must be able to withstand the heat of printing. Transparencies must meet the following conditions.
Material Polyester
To avoid problems, use the multi purpose tray for transparencies and load transparencies with the long side facing the
machine.
If transparencies jam frequently at output, try pulling the leading edge of sheets gently as they are ejected.
11-18
Appendix > Paper
Label
Be sure to feed labels from the multi purpose tray.
For selecting labels, use extreme care so that the adhesive may not come in direct contact with any part of the machine
and that the labels are not easily peeled from the carrier sheet. Adhesives that stick to the drum or rollers and peeled
labels remaining in the machine may cause a failure.
When printing onto labels, you must be liable for the print quality and possible trouble.
Top sheet
Adhesive layer
Carrier sheet
Labels consist of three layers as shown in the illustration. The adhesive layer contains materials that are easily affected
by the force applied in the machine. The carrier sheet bears the top sheet until the label is used. This composition of
labels may cause more problems.
The label surface must be covered completely with the top sheet. Gaps between labels may cause peeling of labels,
resulting in a serious failure.
Some label paper has large margins on the top sheet. When using such paper, do not peel these margins from the
carrier sheet before completing output.
Top sheet
Carrier sheet
11-19
Appendix > Paper
Hagaki (Cardstock)
Burrs
Burrs
Before loading Hagaki (Cardstock) into the multi purpose tray, fan them and align the edges. If the Hagaki (Cardstock)
paper is curled, straighten it before loading. Printing onto curled Hagaki (Cardstock) may cause jams.
Use unfolded Oufuku hagaki (Return postcard) (available at post offices). Some Hagaki (Cardstock) may still have rough
edges developed by a paper cutter on the back side. Remove any such rough edges by placing the Hagaki (Cardstock)
on a flat surface and rubbing the edges gently a few times with a ruler.
Envelopes
Envelopes should be fed from the MP tray with the print-side up or the optional paper feeder with the print-side up.
NOTE
Do not load paper above the load limits located on the paper width guide of the optional paper feeder.
Due to the structure of envelopes, printing evenly over the entire surface may not be possible in some cases. Thin
envelopes in particular may be wrinkled by the machine in some cases as they pass through. Before purchasing
envelopes in volume, try testing a sample to ensure the print quality.
Storing envelopes for a long period may cause them to become wrinkled. Thus, keep the package sealed until you are
ready to use them.
Keep the following points in mind.
• Do not use envelopes with exposed adhesive. In addition, do not use the type of envelope in which the adhesive is
exposed after the top layer is peeled off. Serious damage may be caused if the paper covering the adhesive comes
off in the machine.
• Do not use envelopes with certain special features. For example, do not use envelopes with a grommet for winding a
string to close the flap or envelopes with an open or film-covered window.
• If paper jams occur, load fewer envelopes at once.
Thick Paper
Before loading thick paper in the multi purpose tray, fan it and align the edges. Some thick paper may still have rough
edges developed by a paper cutter on the back side. Remove any such rough edges just as with Hagaki (Cardstock) by
placing the paper on a flat surface and rubbing the edges gently a few times with a ruler. Printing onto paper with rough
edges may cause jams.
NOTE
If the paper is not supplied correctly even after it is smoothed, load the paper in the multi purpose tray with the leading
edge raised a few millimeters.
11-20
Appendix > Paper
Colored Paper
Colored paper must conform to the specifications.
Basic Paper Specifications (page 11-14)
In addition, the pigments in the paper must be able to withstand the heat of printing (up to 200°C or 392°F).
Preprinted Paper
Preprinted paper must conform to the specifications.
Basic Paper Specifications (page 11-14)
The colored ink must be able to withstand the heat of printing. It must be resistant to silicone oil as well. Do not use
paper with a treated surface such as glossy paper used for calendars.
Recycled Paper
Recycled paper must conform to the specifications; however, its whiteness may be considered separately.
Basic Paper Specifications (page 11-14)
NOTE
Before purchasing recycled paper in volume, try testing a sample to ensure satisfactory print quality.
11-21
Appendix > Specifications
Specifications
IMPORTANT
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
NOTE
For more information on using the FAX, refer to the following:
FAX Operation Guide
Machine
Item Description
Type Desktop
Printing Method Electrophotography by semiconductor laser
Paper Weight Cassette 60 to 120 g/m2
Multi Purpose 60 to 220 g/m2, 209.5 g/m2 (Cardstok),
Tray 136 to 163 g/m2 (Banner sheet)
Paper Type Cassette Plain, Rough, Recycled, Preprinted, Bond, Color (Colour),
Prepunched, Letterhead, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8
(Duplex: Same as Simplex)
Multi Purpose Plain, Transparency (OHP film), Rough, Vellum, Labels, Recycled,
Tray Preprinted, Bond, Cardstock, Color (Colour), Prepunched,
Letterhead, Envelope, Thick, High Quality, Custom 1 to 8
Paper Size Cassette A4, A5, A5 (Landscape), A6*1, B5, B6*1, Letter, Legal, Statement,
Statement (Landscape), Executive, Oficio II, Folio, 216 × 340 mm,
16K, B5 (ISO), Envelope DL*1, Envelope C5, Oufuku Hagaki (Return
postcard)*1,
Custom
(ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: 140 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm,
ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: 105 × 148 to 216 × 356 mm)
Multi Purpose A4, A5, A5 (Landscape), A6, B5, B6, Folio, 216 × 340 mm, Letter,
Tray Legal, Statement, Statement (Landscape), Executive, Oficio II, 16K,
B5 (ISO), Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6 3/4,
Envelope Monarch, Envelope DL, Envelope C5, Hagaki (Cardstock),
Oufuku Hagaki (Return postcard), Youkei 4, Youkei 2, Custom
(70 × 148 mm to 216 × 356 mm),
Banner sheet (216 × 470.1 mm to 216 × 915 mm)
Warm-up Time Power on ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: 21 seconds or less
(22°C/71.6°F, ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: 25 seconds or less
60%)
Low Power 10 seconds or less
Mode
Sleep ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: 21 seconds or less
ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: 25 seconds or less
Paper Capacity Cassette 500 sheets (80 g/m2)*2
Multi Purpose 100 sheets (80 g/m2)
Tray
11-22
Appendix > Specifications
Item Description
Output Tray Inner tray ECOSYS M3145idn/ECOSYS M3645idn: 250 sheets (80 g/m2)
Capacity ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn: 500 sheets (80 g/m2)
Image Write System Semiconductor laser and electrophotography
Memory 1024 MB
Interface Standard USB Interface Connector: 1 (Hi-Speed USB)
Network interface: 1 (10 BASE-T/100 BASE-TX/1000 BASE-T)
USB Port: 2 (Hi-Speed USB)
Fax: 1
(ECOSYS M3645idn/ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only)
Option eKUIO: 1
Operating Temperature 10 to 32.5°C/50 to 90.5°F
Environment
Humidity 15 to 80 %
Altitude 3,500 m/11,482 ft maximum
Brightness 1,500 lux maximum
Dimension ECOSYS 18.71" × 18.74" × 22.64"
(W × D × H) M3145idn/ 475 × 476 × 575 mm
ECOSYS
M3645idn
ECOSYS 18.9" × 19.49" × 23.24"
M3655idn/ 480 × 495 × 590 mm
ECOSYS
M3660idn
Weight ECOSYS Approx. 48.5 lb/Approx. 22.5 kg
(without toner M3145idn/
container) ECOSYS
M3645idn
ECOSYS Approx.51.4 lb/Approx. 24.1 kg
M3655idn/
ECOSYS
M3660idn
Space Required ECOSYS 18.71" × 26.23"
(W × D) M3145idn/ 475 × 666 mm
(Using multi ECOSYS
purpose tray) M3645idn
ECOSYS 18.9" × 26.97"
M3655idn/ 480 × 685 mm
ECOSYS
M3660idn
Power Source 120 V Specification Model: 120 V 60 Hz 10.0 A
230 V Specification Model: 220 to 240 V 50/60 Hz 5.6 A
The power consumption of the The information is available at the website below.
product in networked standby (If
http://www.kyoceradocumentsolutions.eu/index/environment/
all network ports are connected.)
green_products/low_power_consumption.html
Options Optional Equipment (page 11-2)
11-23
Appendix > Specifications
Copy Functions
Item Description
Copy Speed ECOSYS A4 45 sheets/min
(Standard M3145idn/ Letter 47 sheets/min
cassette) ECOSYS
Legal 38 sheets/min
M3645idn
B5 36 sheets/min
A5 23 sheets/min
Statement 22 sheets/min
ECOSYS A4 55 sheets/min
M3655idn Letter 57 sheets/min
Legal 46 sheets/min
B5 44 sheets/min
A5 29 sheets/min
A5 (Landscape) 55 sheets/min
Statement 29 sheets/min
Statement (Landscape) 57 sheets/min
A6 29 sheets/min
ECOSYS A4 60 sheets/min
M3660idn Letter 62 sheets/min
Legal 50 sheets/min
B5 48 sheets/min
A5 32 sheets/min
A5 (Landscape) 60 sheets/min
Statement 32 sheets/min
Statement (Landscape) 62 sheets/min
A6 32 sheets/min
Supported Original Types Sheet, Book, 3-dimensional objects (maximum original size: Legal/
Folio)
11-24
Appendix > Specifications
Printer Functions
Item Description
Printing Speed Same as Copying Speed.
Emulations PCL6 (PCL-XL, PCL5e), KPDL3, XPS, Open XPS, TIFF/JPEG, IBM
Proprinter, LQ-850, LinePrint
11-25
Appendix > Specifications
Scanner Functions
Item Description
Resolution 600 dpi, 400 dpi, 300 dpi, 200×400 dpi, 200 dpi, 200×100 dpi
Transmission System SMB, SMTP, FTP, FTP over SSL, USB, TWAIN*4, WIA*4, WSD
11-26
Appendix > Specifications
Document Processor
Item Description
Supported Original Types Sheet originals
Paper Size A4, A5, A5 (Landscape), B5, B6, Folio, Letter, Legal, Statement,
Statement (Landscape), Executive, Oficio II, 16K, B5 (ISO),
Envelope #10, Envelope #9, Envelope #6 3/4, Envelope Monarch,
Envelope DL, Envelope C5,
Oufuku Hagaki (Return postcard), Youkei 4, Youkei 2,
Custom (92 × 162 to 216 × 356 mm)
11-27
Appendix > Specifications
Manual Stapler
(ECOSYS M3655idn/ECOSYS M3660idn only)
Item Description
Paper Weight 90 g/m² or less
Number of stapled sheets*1 20 sheets (80 g/m²) maximum, 15 sheets (90 g/m² or less) maximum
NOTE
Consult your dealer or service representative for recommended paper types.
11-28
Appendix > Glossary
Glossary
Accessibility
The machine is designed featuring good accessibility even for the elderly and those who are physically challenged or
visually impaired. Touch panel is adjustable in two angles.
Apple Talk
AppleTalk offers file sharing and printer sharing and it also enables you to utilize application software that is on another
computer on the same AppleTalk network.
Auto-IP
Auto-IP is a module that enables dynamic IPv4 addresses to be assigned to a device on startup. However, DHCP
requires a DHCP server. Auto-IP is a server-less method of choosing an IP address. IP addresses between 169.254.0.0
to 169.254.255.255 are reserved for Auto-IP and assigned automatically.
Auto Sleep
A mode designed for electrical power saving, activated when the machine is left unused or there is no data transfer for a
specific period. In Sleep mode, power consumption is kept to a minimum.
Bonjour
Bonjour, also known as zero-configuration networking, is a service that automatically detects computers, devices and
services on an IP network. Bonjour, because an industry-standard IP protocol is used, allows devices to automatically
recognize each other without an IP address being specified or DNS server being set. Bonjour also sends and receives
network packets by UDP port 5353. If a firewall is enabled, the user must check that UDP port 5353 is left open so that
Bonjour will run correctly. Some firewalls are set up so as to reject only certain Bonjour packets. If Bonjour does not run
stably, check the firewall settings and ensure that Bonjour is registered on the exceptions list and that Bonjour packets
are accepted. If you install Bonjour on Windows OS, the Windows firewall will be set up correctly for Bonjour.
Custom Box
The Custom Box function stores print data for each individual user on the printer and allows the user to print single or
multiple copies of the stored data later using the printer's operation panel.
Default Gateway
This indicates the device, such as a computer or router, that serves as the entrance/exit (gateway) for accessing
computers outside the network that you are on. When no specific gateway is designated for a destination IP address,
data is sent to the host designated as the Default Gateway.
11-29
Appendix > Glossary
DHCP (IPv6)
DHCP (IPv6) is the next-generation of the Internet's Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol and supports IPv6. It extends
the BOOTP startup protocol that defines the protocols used for transferring configuration information to hosts on the
network. DHCP (IPv6) permits the DHCP server to use its expanded functionality to send configuration parameters to an
IPv6 node. Because the network addresses that can be used are allocated automatically, the IPv6 node management
workload is reduced in systems where the administrator has to exercise close control over IP address allocation.
EcoPrint Mode
A printing mode that helps save toner. Copies made in this mode are thus lighter than normal.
Emulation
The function to interpret and execute other printers' page description languages. The machine emulates operation of
PCL6, KPDL3 (PostScript 3 compatible).
Enhanced WSD
Kyocera's proprietary web services.
Grayscale
A computer color expression. Displayed images of this sort are typically composed of shades of gray, varying from black
at the weakest intensity to white at the strongest, without any other colors. Gray levels are displayed in numerical levels:
that is, white and black only for 1 bit; 256 gray levels (including white and black) for 8 bits; and 65,536 gray levels for 16
bits.
Help
A ? (Help) key is provided on this machine's operation panel. If you are unsure of how to operate the machine, would like
more information on its functions or are having problems getting the machine to work properly, press the ? (Help) key to
view a detailed explanation on the touch panel.
IP Address
An Internet protocol address is a unique number that represents a specific computer or related device on the network.
The format of an IP address is four sets of numbers separated by dots, e.g. 192.168.110.171. Each number should be
between 0 and 255.
11-30
Appendix > Glossary
IPP
IPP (Internet Printing Protocol) is a standard that uses TCP/IP networks such as the Internet to enable print jobs to be
sent between remote computers and printers. IPP is an extension of the HTTP protocol used to view websites and
enables printing to be carried out via routers on printers in remote locations. It also supports the HTTP authentication
mechanisms along with SSL server and client authentication as well as encryption.
Job Box
The Job Box function stores print data on the printer and allows users to print single or multiple copies of the stored data
later using the printer's operation panel.
Outline font
With outline fonts, character outlines are represented with numerical expressions and fonts can be enlarged or reduced
in different ways by changing the numeric values of those expressions. Printing remains clear even if you enlarge fonts,
since the characters are defined with outlines represented with numerical expressions. You can specify the font size in
steps of 0.25 points up to 999.75 points.
PDF/A
This is "ISO 19005-1. Document management - Electronic document file format for long-term preservation - Part 1: Use
of PDF (PDF/A)", and is a file format based on PDF 1.4. It has been standardized as ISO 19005-1, and is a
specialization of PDF, which has been mainly used for printing, for long-term storage. A new part, ISO 19005-2 (PDF/A-
2), is currently being prepared.
PostScript
A page description language developed by Adobe Systems. It enables flexible font functions and highly-functional
graphics, allowing higher quality printing. The first version called Level 1 was launched in 1985, followed by Level 2 that
enabled color printing and two-byte languages (e.g. Japanese) in 1990. In 1996, Level 3 was released as an update for
the Internet access and PDF format as well as gradual improvements in implementation technologies.
11-31
Appendix > Glossary
Printer Driver
The software to enable you to print data created on any application software. The printer driver for the machine is
contained in the DVD enclosed in the package. Install the printer driver on the computer connected to the machine.
RA(Stateless)
The IPv6 router communicates (transmits) information such as the global address prefix using ICMPv6. This information
is the Router Advertisement (RA).
ICMPv6 stands for Internet Control Message Protocol, and is a IPv6 standard defined in the RFC 2463 "Internet Control
Message Protocol (ICMPv6) for the Internet Protocol Version 6 (IPv6) Specification".
RAM Disk
Using part of the printer's memory as a virtual disk, you can set any amount of memory from overall printer memory as a
RAM disk in order to use features such as electronic sorting (shortening print time).
Send as E-mail
A function to send the image data stored in the machine as an E-mail attachment. E-mail addresses can be selected
from the list or entered at each time.
Status Page
The page lists machine conditions, such as the memory capacity, total number of prints and scans, and paper source
settings.
Subnet Mask
The subnet mask is a way of augmenting the network address section of an IP address.
A subnet mask represents all network address sections as 1 and all host address sections as 0. The number of bits in
the prefix indicates the length of the network address. The term "prefix" refers to something added to the beginning and,
in this context, indicates the first section of the IP address. When an IP address is written, the length of the network
address is indicated by the prefix length after a forward slash (/). For example, "24" in the address "133.210.2.0/24". In
this way, "133.210.2.0/24" denotes the IP address "133.210.2.0" with a 24-bit prefix (network section). This new network
address section (originally part of the host address) made possible by the subnet mask is referred to as the subnet
address. When you enter the subnet mask, be sure to set the "DHCP" setting to "Off".
TCP/IP (IPv6)
TCP/IP (IPv6) is based on the current Internet protocol, TCP/IP (IPv4). IPv6 is the next-generation Internet protocol and
expands the available address space, which resolves the problem of the lack of addresses under IPv4, while also
introducing other improvements such as additional security functionality and the capacity to prioritize data transmission.
11-32
Appendix > Glossary
11-33
Index Combine 6-20
Command Center RX 2-53
Common Settings 8-10
A Default Screen 8-10
Accessibility 11-29 Display Status/Log 8-19
Address Book 3-28 Error Handling 8-17
Adding 3-28 Function Defaults 8-15
Contact 3-28 Function Key Assignment 8-19
Editing and Deleting 3-32 Keyboard Layout 8-18
Group 3-31 Low Toner Alert 8-18
Address Book/One Touch 8-23 Measurement 8-18
Adjustment/Maintenance 8-49 Message Banner Print 8-20
Print Density 8-49 Optional Keyboard Type 8-18
Sharpness Adjustment 8-49 Original Settings 8-11
AirPrint 4-11 Paper Settings 8-12
Anti-theft Lock Slot 2-3 Preset Limit 8-17
Apache License (Version 2.0) 1-15 Remote Printing 8-19
Apple Talk 11-29 Sound 8-10
Application 5-11, 8-22 Connecting
Auto Color Correction 8-50 LAN Cable 2-8
Auto Drum Refresh 8-50 Power Cable 2-9
Auto Error Clear 8-48 USB cable 2-9
Auto Form Feed Timeout 11-29 Connection Method 2-7
Auto Panel Reset 8-46 Continuous Scan 6-24
Auto Paper Selection 11-29 Default 8-16
Auto Sleep 2-34, 11-29 Contrast 6-16, 8-49
Auto-IP 11-29 Conventions Used in This Guide xix
Copy 5-16
Settings 8-29
Copy Settings 8-20
Automatic 2-Sided Print Function 1-18
Auto % Priority 8-20
Auto Paper Selection 8-20
B Reserve Next Priority 8-20
Background Density Adjustment 6-17, 8-49 Copy Speed 11-24
Default 8-15 Correcting Black Line 8-50
Bluetooth Settings 8-41 Counting the Number of Pages Printed
Bonjour 11-29 Counter 2-50
Settings 8-31 Each Job Account 9-45
Print Accounting Report 9-46
C Total Accounting 9-45
Cables 2-7 Unknown ID Job 9-48
Card Authentication Kit 11-3 Custom Box 11-29
Card Reader 2-6 Creating a New Box 5-39
Cassette Deleting Documents 5-47
Loading Paper 3-4, 3-8 Editing and Deleting Custom Box 5-41
Paper Size and Media Type 3-15, 8-8 Printing Documents 5-46
Cassette 1 2-2 Send 5-47
Cassette Settings 3-15 Storing Documents 5-42
Cassette/MP Tray Settings 8-8
Cassettes 2 to 5 2-6 D
Character Entry Method 11-11 Data Sanitization 8-44
Checking the Counter 2-50 Data Security 8-43
Checking the Remaining Amount of Toner 7-13 Data Security Kit 11-7
Cleaning 10-2 Date Format 8-46
Glass Platen 10-2 Date/Time 8-46
Registration Roller 10-4
Slit Glass 10-3
Collate 6-13
Default 8-15
Color Selection 6-15
Default 8-15
Index-1
Date/Timer/Energy Saver 8-46 Processor 5-3
Auto Error Clear 8-48 Part Names 2-2
Auto Panel Reset 8-46 dpi 11-30
Date Format 8-46 Drum Refresh 8-50
Date/Time 8-46 Drum Refresh 1 8-50
Energy Saver Recovery Level 8-47 DSM Scan
Error Clear Timer 8-48 Protocol Settings 8-33
Low Power Timer 8-46 Duplex 6-22
Panel Reset Timer 8-46 Duplex (2-sided Original) 6-27
Ping Timeout 8-48 Duplex Cover 2-4
Power Off Rule 8-48
Power Off Timer 8-48 E
Sleep Level 8-46 EcoPrint 6-15, 11-30
Sleep Rules 8-47 Default 8-15
Sleep Timer 8-47 Printer 8-24
Time Zone 8-46 Edit Destination
Unusable Time 8-48 Address Book 3-28
Weekly Timer Settings 8-47 Address Book Defaults 8-23
Default Gateway 11-29 Contact 3-28
Settings 8-29 Edit Restriction 8-24
Default Screen 8-10 Group 3-31
Delete after Printed 6-34 One Touch Key 3-33
Density 6-13 E-mail Settings 2-59
Density Adjustment 8-49 E-mail Subject/Body 6-33
Destination Default 8-16
Adding a Destination 3-28 Emulation 11-30
Address Book 5-20 Selection 8-24
Checking and Editing 5-25 Encrypted PDF Password 6-35
Confirmation Screen of Destinations 5-26 Energy Saver Recovery Level 8-47
Dest. Check before Send 8-21 Energy Saving Control Function 1-18
Entering a New E-mail Address 5-22 Energy Star (ENERGY STAR®) Program 1-19
Entry Check for New Dest. 8-21 Enhanced WSD 11-30
Multi Sending 5-28 Protocol Settings 8-35
One Touch Key 3-33 Enhanced WSD over SSL
Search 5-21 Protocol Settings 8-35
Sort 8-23 Enter key 2-20
Specifying a New PC Folder 5-23 Entry
Device 7-11 File Name 6-25
DHCP 11-30 Subject 6-33
Settings 8-29 Environment 1-3
DHCP (IPv6) 11-30 Error Clear Timer 8-48
Settings 8-30 Error Handling 8-17
Display Brightness 8-50 eSCL
Display Status/Log 8-19 Protocol Settings 8-36
Document Box eSCL over SSL
Custom Box 5-37, 5-39 Protocol Settings 8-36
Job Box 4-12, 5-37 Expansion Memory 11-4
Removable Memory Box 5-37 External Address Book
What is Document Box? 5-37 Default 8-23
Document Box Settings 8-22
Custom Box 8-22
Job Box 8-22 F
Polling Box 8-22 Favorites 5-6
Sub Address Box 8-22 Editing and Deleting 5-10
Document Processor Recalling 5-9
How to Load Originals 5-3 Registering 5-7
Loading Originals 5-3 FAX 8-22
Originals Not Supported by the Document File
Processor 5-3 Format 6-29
Originals Supported by the Document PDF 6-30
Separation 6-33
Index-2
File Format 6-29 Grayscale 11-30
Default 8-15 Group Authorization Set. 9-19
File Management Utility Connection 5-33 Group Authorization 9-19
File Name Entry 6-25 Group List 9-20
Default 8-16 Group Authorization Settings 9-19
File Separation 6-33 Guest Authorization Set. 9-22
Default 8-15 Guest Authorization 9-22
First Copy Time 11-24 Guest Property 9-23
First Print Time 11-25 Guides Provided with the Machine xvi
Front Cover 2-2
Front Cover Open Button 2-2 H
FTP 11-30 Handle 2-2
FTP Client (Transmission) Help 11-30
Protocol Settings 8-32 Help Screen 2-21
FTP Encrypted TX 6-34 High Comp. PDF Image 6-29
Default 8-16 Default 8-17
FTP Server (Reception) Home 8-20
Protocol Settings 8-32 Customize Desktop 2-14
Function Defaults 8-15 Customize Taskbar 2-14
Background Density Adj. (Copy) 8-15 Wallpaper 2-14
Background Density Adj. (Send/Store) 8-15 Home Screen 2-13
Collate 8-15 Host Name 8-27
Color Selection 8-15 HTTP
Continuous Scan (Copy) 8-16 Protocol Settings 8-33
Continuous Scan (FAX) 8-16 HTTPS
Continuous Scan (Send/Store) 8-16 Protocol Settings 8-33
Detect Items to Skip (Copy) 8-17
Detect Items to Skip (Send/Store) 8-17
EcoPrint 8-15 I
E-mail Subject/Body 8-16 Image Quality 6-29
FAX TX Resolution 8-16 Default 8-17
File Format 8-15 Inner Tray 2-2
File Name Entry 8-16 Install
File Separation 8-15 Macintosh 2-45
FTP Encrypted TX 8-16 Software 2-37
High Comp. PDF Image 8-17 Windows 2-38
Image Quality 8-17 Interface Block Setting 8-41
JPEG/TIFF Print 8-16 Internet 8-23
OCR Output Format 8-17 Proxy 8-23, 8-38
OCR Text Recognition 8-17 IP Address 11-30
Original Image (Copy) 8-15 Settings 8-29
Original Image (Send/Store) 8-15 IP Filter (IPv4)
Original Orientation (Copy) 8-15 Settings 8-31
Original Orientation (Send/Store) 8-15 IP Filter (IPv6)
PDF/A 8-17 Settings 8-31
Prevent Bleed-through (Copy) 8-15 IPP 11-31
Prevent Bleed-through (Send/Store) 8-15 Protocol Settings 8-34
Primary OCR Language 8-17 IPP over SSL
Scan Resolution 8-15 Protocol Settings 8-34
Skip Blank Page (Copy) 8-16 IPSec
Skip Blank Page (Send/Store) 8-16 Settings 8-31
XPS Fit to Page 8-16
Zoom 8-16
Function Key Assignment 8-19
Fuser Cover 2-4
G
Glossary 11-29
Google Cloud Print 4-11
GPL/LGPL 1-13
Index-3
J Limited Use of This Product 1-11
Job LINE Connector 2-4
Available Status 7-2 Loading Originals 5-2
Canceling 7-10 Loading Originals in the Document Processor 5-3
Checking History 7-8 Placing Originals on the Platen 5-2
Checking Status 7-2 Local Authorization 9-18
Detailed Information 7-7 Login 2-22
Detailed Information of Histories 7-9 Logout 2-23
Details of the Status Screens 7-3 Long Original 6-34
Displaying History Screen 7-9 Low Power Mode 2-33
Displaying Status Screens 7-2 Low Power Timer 8-46
Pause and Resumption 7-10 Low Toner Alert 8-18
Sending the Log History 7-9 LPD
Job Accounting 9-33 Protocol Settings 8-32
Adding an Account 9-36
Counting the Number of Pages Printed 9-45 M
Default Setting 9-44 Management 9-1
Deleting an Account 9-39 Manual Setting (IPv6) 8-30
Editing an Account 9-38 Manual Stapler 2-6
Enabling Job Accounting 9-34 Manual stapler 11-7
FAX Driver 9-43 Measurement 8-18
Job Accounting Access 9-35 Media Type Setting 8-14
Login 9-47 Mixed Size Originals 6-10, 6-13
Logout 9-47 Monotype Imaging License Agreement 1-14
Overview of Job Accounting 9-33 Mopria 4-11
Print Accounting Report 9-46 Multi Purpose Tray 2-4, 11-31
Printing 9-40 Paper Size and Media Type 3-16, 8-9
Restricting the Use of the Machine 9-37 Multi Sending 5-28
TWAIN 9-41
WIA 9-42
N
Job Box 11-31
NetBEUI 11-31
Deletion of Job Retention 8-22
Protocol Settings 8-31
Private Print Box 4-13
Network
Proof and Hold Box 4-19
Preparation 2-25
Quick Copy Box 4-17
Settings 8-27
Quick Copy Job Retention 8-22
Network Interface 2-7
Specifying the Job Box from a Computer and Storing
Network Interface Connector 2-4
the Job 4-12
Network Interface Kit 11-6
Storage Media 8-22
Network Setup
Stored Job Box 4-15
Wi-Fi Direct Settings 2-31
Job Finish Notice 6-24
Wired Network 2-25
JPEG/TIFF Print 6-36
Wireless Network 2-27
Default 8-16
New E-mail Address 5-22
New PC Folder 5-23
K Notice 1-2
Keyboard Layout 8-18
Knopflerfish License 1-15
O
KPDL 11-31
OCR Dictionary Installation 8-44
One Touch Key
L Adding 3-33
Label 11-19 Editing and Deleting 3-34
LAN Cable 2-7 OpenSSL License 1-13
Connecting 2-8 Operation Panel 2-2
Language 8-5
LDAP
Protocol Settings 8-33
Left Cover 2-5
Legal Information 1-12
Legal Restriction on Copying 1-10
Legal Restriction on Scanning 1-10
Index-4
Option Paper
Card Authentication Kit 11-3 Checking the Remaining Amount of Paper 7-13
Data Security Kit 11-7 Appropriate Paper 11-15
Expansion Memory 11-4 Cassette 8-8
Manual stapler 11-7 Custom Paper Size 8-12
Network Interface Kit 11-6 Default Paper Source 8-13
Optional Keyboard 11-8 Loading Cardstock 3-14
Overview 11-2 Loading Envelopes 3-14
Paper Feeder 11-3 Loading Paper 3-2
Parallel Interface Kit 11-7 Loading Paper in the Cassettes 3-4
Rear Tray 11-7 Loading Paper in the Multi Purpose Tray 3-11
SD Card 11-5 Loading Statement in the Cassettes 3-8
SSD 11-6 Media for Auto 8-13
ThinPrint Option 11-8 Media Type Setting 8-13
Wireless Network Interface Kit 11-7 Multi Purpose Tray 8-9
Option Interface Slot 2-4 Paper Settings 8-12
Optional Applications 11-9 Precaution for Loading Paper 3-3
Optional Function 8-45 Size and Media Type 3-15, 8-8, 11-14
Optional Keyboard 11-8 Special Paper 11-18
Optional Keyboard Type 8-18 Special Paper Action 8-13
Optional Memory 8-42 Specifications 11-14
Optional Network Weight 8-14
Basic 8-39 Paper Feed Mode 8-26
Wireless Network 8-38 Paper Feeder 11-3
Original Paper Jams 10-31
Auto Detect Original Size (DP) 8-11 Cassettes 1 to 5 10-33
Custom Original Size 8-11 Document Processor 10-37
Default Original Size 8-11 Duplex Unit 10-34
Settings 8-11 Inner Tray 10-36
Original eject table 2-2 Inside Rear Cover 10-36
Original Image 6-14 Inside the Machine 10-35
Default 8-15 Jam Location Indicators 10-31
Original Orientation 6-12 Multi Purpose Tray 10-32
Original Orientation (Copy) Paper Length Guide 2-4, 3-5, 3-8
Default 8-15 Paper Selection 6-11
Original Orientation (Send/Store) Paper Settings 8-12
Default 8-15 Paper Stopper 2-2, 2-6, 3-17
Original Settings 8-11 Paper Width Guides 2-4, 3-5, 3-8
Original Size 6-10 Parallel Interface Kit 11-7
Original Size Indicator Plates 2-2 Part Names 2-2
Original SSLeay License 1-13 PDF/A 6-29, 11-31
Original Stopper 2-2, 5-5 Default 8-17
Original Table 2-2 PIN Code Authorization 9-31
Original Width Guides 2-2 Ping 8-37
Outline font 11-31 Platen 2-2
POP3 11-31
P POP3 (E-mail RX)
Panel Reset Timer 8-46 Protocol Settings 8-32
PostScript 11-31
Power Cable
Connecting 2-9
Power Management 1-18
Power Off 2-10
Power Off Rule 8-48
Power Off Timer 8-48
Power On 2-10
Power Switch 2-2
PPM 11-31
Precaution for Loading Paper 3-3
Precautions for Use 1-4
Index-5
Preset Limit 8-17 Report 8-5
Prevent Bleed-through Admin Report Settings 8-6
Default 8-15 Report Print 8-5
Prevent Bleed-thrugh 6-17 Result Report Settings 8-7
Primary Network (Client) 8-38, 8-40 Sending Log History 8-7
Print Density 8-49 Report Print
Print Settings 4-9 Accounting Report 8-6
Printer 8-24 Font List 8-5
Auto Cassette Change 8-26 Network Status 8-6
Copies 8-25 Optional Network Status 8-6
CR Action 8-25 Service Status 8-6
Duplex 8-25 Status Page 8-5
EcoPrint 8-24 Resolution 6-33, 8-26, 11-24, 11-25
Emulation 8-24 Resource Saving - Paper 1-18
Form Feed TimeOut 8-25 Responding to Messages 10-18
Job Name 8-25 REST
KIR 8-26 Protocol Settings 8-36
LF Action 8-25 REST over SSL
MP Tray Priority 8-25 Protocol Settings 8-37
Orientation 8-25 Restart 8-42
Override A4/Letter 8-25 Restart Network 8-38
Paper Feed Mode 8-26
Paper Output 8-25 S
Print setting 4-9 Safety Conventions in This Guide 1-2
Printing Job Terminator 8-26 Saving Documents to USB Memory 5-52
Resolution 8-26 Scan Resolution 6-33
User Name 8-25 Default 8-15
Wide A4 8-25 SD Card 11-5
Printer Driver 11-32 Security Level 8-41
Help 4-10 Security Precautions when Using Wireless LAN 1-10
Printing Documents Stored in Removable USB Send and Forward 8-21
Memory 5-50 Send as E-mail 5-18
Printing from PC 4-2 Send Result Report 8-7
Printing Speed 11-25 Send Settings 8-21
Priority Override 6-25 Broadcast 8-21
Product Library xvii Color TIFF Compression 8-21
Proxy 8-38 Default Screen 8-21
Dest. Check before Send 8-21
Q Entry Check for New Dest. 8-21
Quick No. Search key 2-20 New Destination Entry 8-21
Quick Setup Wizard 2-35 OCR Text Recognition Action 8-21
Quiet Mode 6-25 Recall Destination 8-21
Quiet Mode Settings 8-49 Send and Forward 8-21
Send to Folder (FTP) 5-18
R Send to Folder (SMB) 5-18
RA (Stateless) 11-32 Sending 5-18
Settings 8-30 Preparation for Sending a Document to a PC 3-18
RAM Disk 11-32 Sending Size 6-28
RAM Disk Setting 8-42 Service Setting 8-50
Raw Port Setting Date and Time 2-24
Protocol Settings 8-34 Sharpness 6-16
Rear Cover 1 2-3 Shortcuts 5-14
Rear Tray 2-6, 11-7 Adding 5-14
Recycled Paper 11-21 Editing and Deleting Shortcuts 5-15
Regarding Trade Names 1-12 Simple Login 2-23
Registration Roller 2-5 Simple Login Settings
Regular Maintenance 10-2 Simple Login 9-27
Toner Container Replacement 10-6 Simple Login Setup 9-28
Waste Toner Box Replacement 10-10 Size Dial 2-4
Remote Printing 8-19 Skip Blank Page 6-26
Index-6
Sleep 2-33 System/Network 8-27
Sleep Level 2-34, 8-46 Bluetooth Settings 8-41
Sleep Rules 2-34, 8-47 Data Security 8-43
Sleep Timer 8-47 FAX Server Settings 8-45
Slit Glass 2-2 Interface Block Setting 8-41
SMB Client (Transmission) Network 8-27
Protocol Settings 8-32 OCR Dictionary Installation 8-44
SMTP 11-32 Optional Function 8-45
SMTP (E-mail TX) Optional Memory 8-42
Protocol Settings 8-32 Optional Network 8-38
SNMPv1/v2c Primary Network (Client) 8-38, 8-40
Protocol Settings 8-33 RAM Disk Setting 8-42
SNMPv3 Restart 8-42
Protocol Settings 8-33 Security Level 8-41
Solving Malfunctions 10-13
Sound 8-10 T
Specifications 11-22 TCP/IP 11-32
Copy Functions 11-24 Settings 8-29, 8-30
Document Processor 11-27 TCP/IP (IPv4)
Machine 11-22 Settings 2-25, 8-29
Manual Stapler 11-28 TCP/IP (IPv6) 11-30
Paper Feeder (500-sheet) (Option) 11-27 Settings 8-30
Scanner Functions 11-26 TEL Connector 2-4
Specifying Destination 5-20 ThinPrint
SSD 11-6 Protocol Settings 8-35
SSD Initialization 8-43 ThinPrint Option 11-8
SSL 8-37 ThinPrint over SSL
Status Page 11-32 Protocol Settings 8-35
Status/Job Cancel 7-1 Time Zone 8-46
Storing Size 6-35 Toner Container 2-5
Subnet Mask 11-32 Toner Container Lock Lever 2-5
Settings 8-29 Toner Container Replacement 10-6
Supplies Toner Save Level (EcoPrint) 8-49
Checking the Remaining Amount 7-13 Touch Panel 2-13
Symbols 1-2 Tray Extension 2-4
System Menu 8-2 Troubleshooting 10-13
Address Book/One Touch 8-23 TWAIN 11-33
Adjustment/Maintenance 8-49 Scanning using TWAIN 5-32
Application 8-22 Setting TWAIN Driver 2-47
Cassette/MP Tray Settings 8-8
Common Settings 8-10
Copy 8-20 U
Date/Timer/Energy Saver 8-46 USB 11-33
Document Box 8-22 USB Cable
FAX 8-22 Connecting 2-9
Home 2-13 USB Interface 2-7
Internet 8-23 USB Interface Connector 2-4
Language 8-5 USB Memory
Operation Method 8-2 Printing 5-50
Printer 8-24 Remove 5-54
Quick Setup Wizard 2-35 Save 5-52
Report 8-5 USB Memory Slot 2-2
Send 8-21
System/Network 8-27
User Login/Job Accounting 8-24
User Property 8-7, 9-11
Index-7
User Login Administration 9-2
Adding a User 9-6
Changing User Properties 9-9
Enabling User Login Administration 9-3
FAX Driver 9-17
Group Authorization Settings 9-19
Guest Authorization Set. 9-22
ID Card Settings 9-30
Local Authentication 9-18
Login 2-22
Logout 2-23
Obtain NW User Property 9-25
Overview of User Login Administration 9-2
Password Policy Settings 9-5
PIN Code Authentication 9-31
Printing 9-13
Simple Login Settings 9-27
TWAIN 9-15
User Account Lockout Setting 9-4
WIA 9-16
User Login/Job Accounting 8-24
Job Accounting 9-33
Unknown ID Job 9-48
Unknown User Settings 9-48
User Login 9-2
User Property 8-7
W
Waste Toner Box 2-5
Waste Toner Box Replacement 10-10
Weekly Timer Settings 8-47
WIA 11-33
Setting WIA Driver 2-49
Wi-Fi
Settings 2-27, 8-27
Wi-Fi Direct
Printing 4-11
Settings 2-31, 8-27
Wireless Connection 1-10
Wireless Network
Settings 2-27, 8-38
Wireless Network Interface Kit 11-7
WSD Print
Protocol Settings 8-32
WSD Scan 5-30
Protocol Settings 8-32
X
XPS Fit to Page 6-36
Default 8-16
Z
Zoom 6-18
Default 8-16
Index-8
KYOCERA Document Solutions America, Inc. KYOCERA Document Solutions Asia Limited
Headquarters 13/F.,Mita Centre, 552-566, Castle Peak Road Tsuen Wan,
225 Sand Road, New Territories, Hong Kong
Fairfield, New Jersey 07004-0008, USA Phone: +852-2496-5678
Phone: +1-973-808-8444 Fax: +852-2610-2063
Fax: +1-973-882-6000
Latin America KYOCERA Document Solutions
8240 NW 52nd Terrace Dawson Building, Suite 100 (China) Corporation
Miami, Florida 33166, USA 8F, No. 288 Nanjing Road West, Huangpu District,
Phone: +1-305-421-6640 Shanghai,200003, China
Fax: +1-305-421-6666 Phone: +86-21-5301-1777
Fax: +86-21-5302-8300
KYOCERA Document Solutions Canada, Ltd.
6120 Kestrel Rd., Mississauga, ON L5T 1S8, KYOCERA Document Solutions
Canada (Thailand) Corp., Ltd.
Phone: +1-905-670-4425 335 Ratchadapisek Road, Wongsawang, Bangsue,
Fax: +1-905-670-8116 Bangkok 10800,
Thailand
KYOCERA Document Solutions Phone: +66-2-586-0333
Mexico, S.A. de C.V. Fax: +66-2-586-0278
Calle Arquimedes No. 130, 4 Piso, Colonia Polanco
Chapultepec, Delegacion Miguel Hidalgo, KYOCERA Document Solutions
Distrito Federal, C.P. 11560, México Singapore Pte. Ltd.
Phone: +52-555-383-2741 12 Tai Seng Street #04-01A,
Fax: +52-555-383-7804 Luxasia Building, Singapore 534118
Phone: +65-6741-8733
KYOCERA Document Solutions Brazil, Ltda. Fax: +65-6748-3788
Alameda África, 545, Pólo Empresarial Consbrás,
Tamboré, Santana de Parnaíba, State of São Paulo, CEP KYOCERA Document Solutions
06543-306, Brazil Hong Kong Limited
Phone: +55-11-2424-5353
16/F.,Mita Centre, 552-566, Castle Peak Road Tsuen Wan,
Fax: +55-11-2424-5304
New Territories, Hong Kong
Phone: +852-3582-4000
KYOCERA Document Solutions Chile SpA Fax: +852-3185-1399
Jose Ananias 505, Macul. Santiago, Chile
Phone: +562-2350-7000 KYOCERA Document Solutions
Fax: +562-2350-7150 Taiwan Corporation
6F., No.37, Sec. 3, Minquan E. Rd.,
KYOCERA Document Solutions
Zhongshan Dist., Taipei 104, Taiwan R.O.C.
Australia Pty. Ltd. Phone: +886-2-2507-6709
Level 3, 6-10 Talavera Road North Ryde N.S.W, 2113, Fax: +886-2-2507-8432
Australia
Phone: +61-2-9888-9999 KYOCERA Document Solutions Korea Co., Ltd.
Fax: +61-2-9888-9588 #10F Daewoo Foundation Bldg 18, Toegye-ro, Jung-gu,
Seoul, Korea
KYOCERA Document Solutions Phone: +822-6933-4050
New Zealand Ltd. Fax: +822-747-0084
Ground Floor, 19 Byron Avenue, Takapuna, Auckland,
New Zealand KYOCERA Document Solutions
Phone: +64-9-415-4517 India Private Limited
Fax: +64-9-415-4597 Second Floor, Centrum Plaza, Golf Course Road,
Sector-53, Gurgaon, Haryana 122002, India
Phone: +91-0124-4671000
Fax: +91-0124-4671001
KYOCERA Document Solutions Europe B.V. KYOCERA Document Solutions
Bloemlaan 4, 2132 NP Hoofddorp, Deutschland GmbH
The Netherlands Otto-Hahn-Strasse 12, 40670 Meerbusch,
Phone: +31-20-654-0000 Germany
Fax: +31-20-653-1256 Phone: +49-2159-9180
Fax: +49-2159-918100
KYOCERA Document Solutions Nederland B.V.
Beechavenue 25, 1119 RA Schiphol-Rijk, KYOCERA Document Solutions Austria GmbH
The Netherlands Wienerbergstraße 11, Turm A, 18. OG, 1100 Wien,
Phone: +31-20-5877200 Austria
Fax: +31-20-5877260 Phone: +43-1-863380
Fax: +43-1-86338-400
KYOCERA Document Solutions (U.K.) Limited
Eldon Court, 75-77 London Road, KYOCERA Document Solutions Nordic AB
Reading, Berkshire RG1 5BS, Esbogatan 16B 164 75 Kista, Sweden
United Kingdom Phone: +46-8-546-550-00
Phone: +44-118-931-1500 Fax: +46-8-546-550-10
Fax: +44-118-931-1108
KYOCERA Document Solutions Norge Nuf
KYOCERA Document Solutions Italia S.p.A.
Olaf Helsetsv. 6, 0619 Oslo, Norway
Via Monfalcone 15, 20132, Milano, Italy, Phone: +47-22-62-73-00
Phone: +39-02-921791 Fax: +47-22-62-72-00
Fax: +39-02-92179-600
KYOCERA Document Solutions Danmark A/S
KYOCERA Document Solutions Belgium N.V.
Ejby Industrivej 60, DK-2600 Glostrup,
Sint-Martinusweg 199-201 1930 Zaventem, Denmark
Belgium Phone: +45-70223880
Phone: +32-2-7209270 Fax: +45-45765850
Fax: +32-2-7208748
KYOCERA Document Solutions Portugal Lda.
KYOCERA Document Solutions France S.A.S.
Rua do Centro Cultural, 41 (Alvalade) 1700-106 Lisboa,
Espace Technologique de St Aubin Portugal
Route de I’Orme 91195 Gif-sur-Yvette CEDEX, Phone: +351-21-843-6780
France Fax: +351-21-849-3312
Phone: +33-1-69852600
Fax: +33-1-69853409 KYOCERA Document Solutions
KYOCERA Document Solutions Espana, S.A. South Africa (Pty) Ltd.
Edificio Kyocera, Avda. de Manacor No.2, KYOCERA House, Hertford Office Park,
28290 Las Matas (Madrid), Spain 90 Bekker Road (Cnr. Allandale), Midrand, South Africa
Phone: +34-91-6318392 Phone: +27-11-540-2600
Fax: +34-91-6318219 Fax: +27-11-466-3050